]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - src/xterm.c
Fix problems caught with --enable-gcc-warnings
[gnu-emacs] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
22
23 #include <config.h>
24 #include <stdio.h>
25 #ifdef USE_CAIRO
26 #include <math.h>
27 #endif
28
29 #include "lisp.h"
30 #include "blockinput.h"
31 #include "syssignal.h"
32
33 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
34 if this is not done before the other system files. */
35 #include "xterm.h"
36 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
37
38 /* If we have Xfixes extension, use it for pointer blanking. */
39 #ifdef HAVE_XFIXES
40 #include <X11/extensions/Xfixes.h>
41 #endif
42
43 /* Using Xft implies that XRender is available. */
44 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
45 #include <X11/extensions/Xrender.h>
46 #endif
47
48 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
49 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
50 #ifndef makedev
51 #include <sys/types.h>
52 #endif /* makedev */
53
54 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
55
56 #include "systime.h"
57
58 #include <fcntl.h>
59 #include <errno.h>
60 #include <sys/stat.h>
61 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
62 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
63
64 #include "charset.h"
65 #include "character.h"
66 #include "coding.h"
67 #include "frame.h"
68 #include "dispextern.h"
69 #include "fontset.h"
70 #include "termhooks.h"
71 #include "termopts.h"
72 #include "termchar.h"
73 #include "emacs-icon.h"
74 #include "disptab.h"
75 #include "buffer.h"
76 #include "window.h"
77 #include "keyboard.h"
78 #include "intervals.h"
79 #include "process.h"
80 #include "atimer.h"
81 #include "keymap.h"
82 #include "font.h"
83 #include "xsettings.h"
84 #include "xgselect.h"
85 #include "sysselect.h"
86 #include "menu.h"
87
88 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
89 #include <X11/Shell.h>
90 #endif
91
92 #include <unistd.h>
93
94 #ifdef USE_GTK
95 #include "gtkutil.h"
96 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
97 #include <X11/Xproto.h>
98 #endif
99 #endif
100
101 #if defined (USE_LUCID) || defined (USE_MOTIF)
102 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
103 #endif
104
105 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
106 #if !defined (NO_EDITRES)
107 #define HACK_EDITRES
108 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages (Widget, XtPointer, XEvent *, Boolean *);
109 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
110
111 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
112
113 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
114 #if defined USE_MOTIF
115 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* For LESSTIF_VERSION */
116 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
117 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
118
119 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
120 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
121 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
122 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
123 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
124 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
125 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
126 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
127 #ifndef XtNpickTop
128 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
129 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
130 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
131 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
132
133 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
134
135 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
136 #include "widget.h"
137 #ifndef XtNinitialState
138 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
139 #endif
140 #endif
141
142 #include "bitmaps/gray.xbm"
143
144 #ifdef HAVE_XKB
145 #include <X11/XKBlib.h>
146 #endif
147
148 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
149 #ifdef USE_XIM
150 bool use_xim = true;
151 #else
152 bool use_xim = false; /* configure --without-xim */
153 #endif
154
155 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
156 start. */
157
158 static bool any_help_event_p;
159
160 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
161 use. */
162
163 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
164
165 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
166
167 /* The application context for Xt use. */
168 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
169 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
170
171 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
172 static bool toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
173
174 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
175
176 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
177 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
178 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
179
180 static Time ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
181
182 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
183
184 static int x_noop_count;
185
186 #ifdef USE_GTK
187 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
188 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
189 #endif
190
191 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
192 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
193
194 enum xembed_info
195 {
196 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
197 };
198
199 enum xembed_message
200 {
201 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
202 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
203 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
204 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
205 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
206 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
207 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
208 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
209
210 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
211 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
212 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
213 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
214 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
215 };
216
217 static void x_free_cr_resources (struct frame *);
218 static bool x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
219 static void x_raise_frame (struct frame *);
220 static void x_lower_frame (struct frame *);
221 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
222 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
223 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
224
225 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *,
226 enum glyph_row_area, GC);
227 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window, int);
228 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
229 enum scroll_bar_part *,
230 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
231 Time *);
232 static void x_horizontal_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
233 enum scroll_bar_part *,
234 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
235 Time *);
236 static bool x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, const XPropertyEvent *);
237 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
238 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
239 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, bool);
240 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *,
241 const XEvent *, int *,
242 struct input_event *);
243 #if ! (defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || defined USE_MOTIF)
244 static int x_dispatch_event (XEvent *, Display *);
245 #endif
246 static void x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *, int);
247 static void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *, ptrdiff_t);
248 static void x_initialize (void);
249
250 static bool get_current_wm_state (struct frame *, Window, int *, bool *);
251
252 /* Flush display of frame F. */
253
254 static void
255 x_flush (struct frame *f)
256 {
257 eassert (f && FRAME_X_P (f));
258 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
259 connection may be broken. */
260 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
261 return;
262
263 block_input ();
264 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
265 unblock_input ();
266 }
267
268
269 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
270 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
271 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
272 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
273 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
274 performance. */
275
276 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
277
278 \f
279 /***********************************************************************
280 Debugging
281 ***********************************************************************/
282
283 #if false
284
285 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
286 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
287
288 struct record
289 {
290 char *locus;
291 int type;
292 };
293
294 struct record event_record[100];
295
296 int event_record_index;
297
298 void
299 record_event (char *locus, int type)
300 {
301 if (event_record_index == ARRAYELTS (event_record))
302 event_record_index = 0;
303
304 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
305 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
306 event_record_index++;
307 }
308
309 #endif
310
311 #ifdef USE_CAIRO
312
313 #define FRAME_CR_CONTEXT(f) ((f)->output_data.x->cr_context)
314 #define FRAME_CR_SURFACE(f) ((f)->output_data.x->cr_surface)
315
316 static struct x_gc_ext_data *
317 x_gc_get_ext_data (struct frame *f, GC gc, int create_if_not_found_p)
318 {
319 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
320 XEDataObject object;
321 XExtData **head, *ext_data;
322
323 object.gc = gc;
324 head = XEHeadOfExtensionList (object);
325 ext_data = XFindOnExtensionList (head, dpyinfo->ext_codes->extension);
326 if (ext_data == NULL)
327 {
328 if (!create_if_not_found_p)
329 return NULL;
330 else
331 {
332 ext_data = xzalloc (sizeof (*ext_data));
333 ext_data->number = dpyinfo->ext_codes->extension;
334 ext_data->private_data = xzalloc (sizeof (struct x_gc_ext_data));
335 XAddToExtensionList (head, ext_data);
336 }
337 }
338 return (struct x_gc_ext_data *) ext_data->private_data;
339 }
340
341 static void
342 x_extension_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
343 {
344 XExtCodes *ext_codes = XAddExtension (dpyinfo->display);
345
346 dpyinfo->ext_codes = ext_codes;
347 }
348
349 static void
350 x_cr_destroy_surface (struct frame *f)
351 {
352 if (FRAME_CR_SURFACE (f))
353 {
354 cairo_t *cr = FRAME_CR_CONTEXT (f);
355 cairo_surface_destroy (FRAME_CR_SURFACE (f));
356 FRAME_CR_SURFACE (f) = 0;
357 if (cr) cairo_destroy (cr);
358 FRAME_CR_CONTEXT (f) = NULL;
359 }
360 }
361
362 cairo_t *
363 x_begin_cr_clip (struct frame *f, GC gc)
364 {
365 cairo_t *cr = FRAME_CR_CONTEXT (f);
366
367 if (!cr)
368 {
369
370 if (! FRAME_CR_SURFACE (f))
371 {
372 cairo_surface_t *surface;
373 surface = cairo_xlib_surface_create (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
374 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
375 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->visual,
376 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f),
377 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f));
378 cr = cairo_create (surface);
379 cairo_surface_destroy (surface);
380 }
381 else
382 cr = cairo_create (FRAME_CR_SURFACE (f));
383 FRAME_CR_CONTEXT (f) = cr;
384 }
385 cairo_save (cr);
386
387 if (gc)
388 {
389 struct x_gc_ext_data *gc_ext = x_gc_get_ext_data (f, gc, 0);
390
391 if (gc_ext && gc_ext->n_clip_rects)
392 {
393 int i;
394
395 for (i = 0; i < gc_ext->n_clip_rects; i++)
396 cairo_rectangle (cr, gc_ext->clip_rects[i].x,
397 gc_ext->clip_rects[i].y,
398 gc_ext->clip_rects[i].width,
399 gc_ext->clip_rects[i].height);
400 cairo_clip (cr);
401 }
402 }
403
404 return cr;
405 }
406
407 void
408 x_end_cr_clip (struct frame *f)
409 {
410 cairo_restore (FRAME_CR_CONTEXT (f));
411 }
412
413 void
414 x_set_cr_source_with_gc_foreground (struct frame *f, GC gc)
415 {
416 XGCValues xgcv;
417 XColor color;
418
419 XGetGCValues (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
420 color.pixel = xgcv.foreground;
421 x_query_color (f, &color);
422 cairo_set_source_rgb (FRAME_CR_CONTEXT (f), color.red / 65535.0,
423 color.green / 65535.0, color.blue / 65535.0);
424 }
425
426 void
427 x_set_cr_source_with_gc_background (struct frame *f, GC gc)
428 {
429 XGCValues xgcv;
430 XColor color;
431
432 XGetGCValues (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
433 color.pixel = xgcv.background;
434 x_query_color (f, &color);
435 cairo_set_source_rgb (FRAME_CR_CONTEXT (f), color.red / 65535.0,
436 color.green / 65535.0, color.blue / 65535.0);
437 }
438
439 /* Fringe bitmaps. */
440
441 static int max_fringe_bmp = 0;
442 static cairo_pattern_t **fringe_bmp = 0;
443
444 static void
445 x_cr_define_fringe_bitmap (int which, unsigned short *bits, int h, int wd)
446 {
447 int i, stride;
448 cairo_surface_t *surface;
449 unsigned char *data;
450 cairo_pattern_t *pattern;
451
452 if (which >= max_fringe_bmp)
453 {
454 i = max_fringe_bmp;
455 max_fringe_bmp = which + 20;
456 fringe_bmp = (cairo_pattern_t **) xrealloc (fringe_bmp, max_fringe_bmp * sizeof (cairo_pattern_t *));
457 while (i < max_fringe_bmp)
458 fringe_bmp[i++] = 0;
459 }
460
461 block_input ();
462
463 surface = cairo_image_surface_create (CAIRO_FORMAT_A1, wd, h);
464 stride = cairo_image_surface_get_stride (surface);
465 data = cairo_image_surface_get_data (surface);
466
467 for (i = 0; i < h; i++)
468 {
469 *((unsigned short *) data) = bits[i];
470 data += stride;
471 }
472
473 cairo_surface_mark_dirty (surface);
474 pattern = cairo_pattern_create_for_surface (surface);
475 cairo_surface_destroy (surface);
476
477 unblock_input ();
478
479 fringe_bmp[which] = pattern;
480 }
481
482 static void
483 x_cr_destroy_fringe_bitmap (int which)
484 {
485 if (which >= max_fringe_bmp)
486 return;
487
488 if (fringe_bmp[which])
489 {
490 block_input ();
491 cairo_pattern_destroy (fringe_bmp[which]);
492 unblock_input ();
493 }
494 fringe_bmp[which] = 0;
495 }
496
497 static void
498 x_cr_draw_image (struct frame *f, GC gc, cairo_pattern_t *image,
499 int src_x, int src_y, int width, int height,
500 int dest_x, int dest_y, bool overlay_p)
501 {
502 cairo_t *cr;
503 cairo_matrix_t matrix;
504 cairo_surface_t *surface;
505 cairo_format_t format;
506
507 cr = x_begin_cr_clip (f, gc);
508 if (overlay_p)
509 cairo_rectangle (cr, dest_x, dest_y, width, height);
510 else
511 {
512 x_set_cr_source_with_gc_background (f, gc);
513 cairo_rectangle (cr, dest_x, dest_y, width, height);
514 cairo_fill_preserve (cr);
515 }
516 cairo_clip (cr);
517 cairo_matrix_init_translate (&matrix, src_x - dest_x, src_y - dest_y);
518 cairo_pattern_set_matrix (image, &matrix);
519 cairo_pattern_get_surface (image, &surface);
520 format = cairo_image_surface_get_format (surface);
521 if (format != CAIRO_FORMAT_A8 && format != CAIRO_FORMAT_A1)
522 {
523 cairo_set_source (cr, image);
524 cairo_fill (cr);
525 }
526 else
527 {
528 x_set_cr_source_with_gc_foreground (f, gc);
529 cairo_mask (cr, image);
530 }
531 x_end_cr_clip (f);
532 }
533
534 void
535 x_cr_draw_frame (cairo_t *cr, struct frame *f)
536 {
537 int width, height;
538
539 width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
540 height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
541
542 x_free_cr_resources (f);
543 FRAME_CR_CONTEXT (f) = cr;
544 x_clear_area (f, 0, 0, width, height);
545 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, width, height);
546 FRAME_CR_CONTEXT (f) = NULL;
547 }
548
549 static cairo_status_t
550 x_cr_accumulate_data (void *closure, const unsigned char *data,
551 unsigned int length)
552 {
553 Lisp_Object *acc = (Lisp_Object *) closure;
554
555 *acc = Fcons (make_unibyte_string ((char const *) data, length), *acc);
556
557 return CAIRO_STATUS_SUCCESS;
558 }
559
560 static void
561 x_cr_destroy (Lisp_Object arg)
562 {
563 cairo_t *cr = (cairo_t *) XSAVE_POINTER (arg, 0);
564
565 block_input ();
566 cairo_destroy (cr);
567 unblock_input ();
568 }
569
570 Lisp_Object
571 x_cr_export_frames (Lisp_Object frames, cairo_surface_type_t surface_type)
572 {
573 struct frame *f;
574 cairo_surface_t *surface;
575 cairo_t *cr;
576 int width, height;
577 void (*surface_set_size_func) (cairo_surface_t *, double, double) = NULL;
578 Lisp_Object acc = Qnil;
579 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
580
581 Fredisplay (Qt);
582
583 f = XFRAME (XCAR (frames));
584 frames = XCDR (frames);
585 width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
586 height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
587
588 block_input ();
589 #ifdef CAIRO_HAS_PDF_SURFACE
590 if (surface_type == CAIRO_SURFACE_TYPE_PDF)
591 {
592 surface = cairo_pdf_surface_create_for_stream (x_cr_accumulate_data, &acc,
593 width, height);
594 surface_set_size_func = cairo_pdf_surface_set_size;
595 }
596 else
597 #endif
598 #ifdef CAIRO_HAS_PNG_FUNCTIONS
599 if (surface_type == CAIRO_SURFACE_TYPE_IMAGE)
600 surface = cairo_image_surface_create (CAIRO_FORMAT_RGB24, width, height);
601 else
602 #endif
603 #ifdef CAIRO_HAS_PS_SURFACE
604 if (surface_type == CAIRO_SURFACE_TYPE_PS)
605 {
606 surface = cairo_ps_surface_create_for_stream (x_cr_accumulate_data, &acc,
607 width, height);
608 surface_set_size_func = cairo_ps_surface_set_size;
609 }
610 else
611 #endif
612 #ifdef CAIRO_HAS_SVG_SURFACE
613 if (surface_type == CAIRO_SURFACE_TYPE_SVG)
614 surface = cairo_svg_surface_create_for_stream (x_cr_accumulate_data, &acc,
615 width, height);
616 else
617 #endif
618 abort ();
619
620 cr = cairo_create (surface);
621 cairo_surface_destroy (surface);
622 record_unwind_protect (x_cr_destroy, make_save_ptr (cr));
623 unblock_input ();
624
625 while (1)
626 {
627 QUIT;
628
629 block_input ();
630 x_free_cr_resources (f);
631 FRAME_CR_CONTEXT (f) = cr;
632 x_clear_area (f, 0, 0, width, height);
633 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, width, height);
634 FRAME_CR_CONTEXT (f) = NULL;
635 unblock_input ();
636
637 if (NILP (frames))
638 break;
639
640 block_input ();
641 cairo_surface_show_page (surface);
642 f = XFRAME (XCAR (frames));
643 frames = XCDR (frames);
644 width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
645 height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
646 if (surface_set_size_func)
647 (*surface_set_size_func) (surface, width, height);
648 unblock_input ();
649 }
650
651 #ifdef CAIRO_HAS_PNG_FUNCTIONS
652 if (surface_type == CAIRO_SURFACE_TYPE_IMAGE)
653 {
654 block_input ();
655 cairo_surface_flush (surface);
656 cairo_surface_write_to_png_stream (surface, x_cr_accumulate_data, &acc);
657 unblock_input ();
658 }
659 #endif
660 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
661
662 return CALLN (Fapply, intern ("concat"), Fnreverse (acc));
663 }
664
665 #endif /* USE_CAIRO */
666
667 static void
668 x_free_cr_resources (struct frame *f)
669 {
670 #ifdef USE_CAIRO
671 if (f == NULL)
672 {
673 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
674 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
675 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
676 x_free_cr_resources (XFRAME (frame));
677 }
678 else
679 {
680 cairo_t *cr = FRAME_CR_CONTEXT (f);
681
682 if (cr)
683 {
684 cairo_surface_t *surface = cairo_get_target (cr);
685
686 if (cairo_surface_get_type (surface) == CAIRO_SURFACE_TYPE_XLIB)
687 {
688 cairo_destroy (cr);
689 FRAME_CR_CONTEXT (f) = NULL;
690 }
691 }
692 }
693 #endif
694 }
695
696 static void
697 x_set_clip_rectangles (struct frame *f, GC gc, XRectangle *rectangles, int n)
698 {
699 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, rectangles, n, Unsorted);
700 #ifdef USE_CAIRO
701 eassert (n >= 0 && n <= MAX_CLIP_RECTS);
702
703 {
704 struct x_gc_ext_data *gc_ext = x_gc_get_ext_data (f, gc, 1);
705
706 gc_ext->n_clip_rects = n;
707 memcpy (gc_ext->clip_rects, rectangles, sizeof (XRectangle) * n);
708 }
709 #endif
710 }
711
712 static void
713 x_reset_clip_rectangles (struct frame *f, GC gc)
714 {
715 XSetClipMask (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, None);
716 #ifdef USE_CAIRO
717 {
718 struct x_gc_ext_data *gc_ext = x_gc_get_ext_data (f, gc, 0);
719
720 if (gc_ext)
721 gc_ext->n_clip_rects = 0;
722 }
723 #endif
724 }
725
726 static void
727 x_fill_rectangle (struct frame *f, GC gc, int x, int y, int width, int height)
728 {
729 #ifdef USE_CAIRO
730 cairo_t *cr;
731
732 cr = x_begin_cr_clip (f, gc);
733 x_set_cr_source_with_gc_foreground (f, gc);
734 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, width, height);
735 cairo_fill (cr);
736 x_end_cr_clip (f);
737 #else
738 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
739 gc, x, y, width, height);
740 #endif
741 }
742
743 static void
744 x_draw_rectangle (struct frame *f, GC gc, int x, int y, int width, int height)
745 {
746 #ifdef USE_CAIRO
747 cairo_t *cr;
748
749 cr = x_begin_cr_clip (f, gc);
750 x_set_cr_source_with_gc_foreground (f, gc);
751 cairo_rectangle (cr, x + 0.5, y + 0.5, width, height);
752 cairo_set_line_width (cr, 1);
753 cairo_stroke (cr);
754 x_end_cr_clip (f);
755 #else
756 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
757 gc, x, y, width, height);
758 #endif
759 }
760
761 static void
762 x_clear_window (struct frame *f)
763 {
764 #ifdef USE_CAIRO
765 cairo_t *cr;
766
767 cr = x_begin_cr_clip (f, NULL);
768 x_set_cr_source_with_gc_background (f, f->output_data.x->normal_gc);
769 cairo_paint (cr);
770 x_end_cr_clip (f);
771 #else
772 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
773 #endif
774 }
775
776 #ifdef USE_CAIRO
777 static void
778 x_fill_trapezoid_for_relief (struct frame *f, GC gc, int x, int y,
779 int width, int height, int top_p)
780 {
781 cairo_t *cr;
782
783 cr = x_begin_cr_clip (f, gc);
784 x_set_cr_source_with_gc_foreground (f, gc);
785 cairo_move_to (cr, top_p ? x : x + height, y);
786 cairo_line_to (cr, x, y + height);
787 cairo_line_to (cr, top_p ? x + width - height : x + width, y + height);
788 cairo_line_to (cr, x + width, y);
789 cairo_fill (cr);
790 x_end_cr_clip (f);
791 }
792
793 enum corners
794 {
795 CORNER_BOTTOM_RIGHT, /* 0 -> pi/2 */
796 CORNER_BOTTOM_LEFT, /* pi/2 -> pi */
797 CORNER_TOP_LEFT, /* pi -> 3pi/2 */
798 CORNER_TOP_RIGHT, /* 3pi/2 -> 2pi */
799 CORNER_LAST
800 };
801
802 static void
803 x_erase_corners_for_relief (struct frame *f, GC gc, int x, int y,
804 int width, int height,
805 double radius, double margin, int corners)
806 {
807 cairo_t *cr;
808 int i;
809
810 cr = x_begin_cr_clip (f, gc);
811 x_set_cr_source_with_gc_background (f, gc);
812 for (i = 0; i < CORNER_LAST; i++)
813 if (corners & (1 << i))
814 {
815 double xm, ym, xc, yc;
816
817 if (i == CORNER_TOP_LEFT || i == CORNER_BOTTOM_LEFT)
818 xm = x - margin, xc = xm + radius;
819 else
820 xm = x + width + margin, xc = xm - radius;
821 if (i == CORNER_TOP_LEFT || i == CORNER_TOP_RIGHT)
822 ym = y - margin, yc = ym + radius;
823 else
824 ym = y + height + margin, yc = ym - radius;
825
826 cairo_move_to (cr, xm, ym);
827 cairo_arc (cr, xc, yc, radius, i * M_PI_2, (i + 1) * M_PI_2);
828 }
829 cairo_clip (cr);
830 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, width, height);
831 cairo_fill (cr);
832 x_end_cr_clip (f);
833 }
834
835 static void
836 x_draw_horizontal_wave (struct frame *f, GC gc, int x, int y,
837 int width, int height, int wave_length)
838 {
839 cairo_t *cr;
840 double dx = wave_length, dy = height - 1;
841 int xoffset, n;
842
843 cr = x_begin_cr_clip (f, gc);
844 x_set_cr_source_with_gc_foreground (f, gc);
845 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, width, height);
846 cairo_clip (cr);
847
848 if (x >= 0)
849 {
850 xoffset = x % (wave_length * 2);
851 if (xoffset == 0)
852 xoffset = wave_length * 2;
853 }
854 else
855 xoffset = x % (wave_length * 2) + wave_length * 2;
856 n = (width + xoffset) / wave_length + 1;
857 if (xoffset > wave_length)
858 {
859 xoffset -= wave_length;
860 --n;
861 y += height - 1;
862 dy = -dy;
863 }
864
865 cairo_move_to (cr, x - xoffset + 0.5, y + 0.5);
866 while (--n >= 0)
867 {
868 cairo_rel_line_to (cr, dx, dy);
869 dy = -dy;
870 }
871 cairo_set_line_width (cr, 1);
872 cairo_stroke (cr);
873 x_end_cr_clip (f);
874 }
875 #endif
876
877 \f
878 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
879
880 struct x_display_info *
881 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
882 {
883 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
884
885 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
886 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
887 return dpyinfo;
888
889 return 0;
890 }
891
892 static Window
893 x_find_topmost_parent (struct frame *f)
894 {
895 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x;
896 Window win = None, wi = x->parent_desc;
897 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
898
899 while (wi != FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
900 {
901 Window root;
902 Window *children;
903 unsigned int nchildren;
904
905 win = wi;
906 if (XQueryTree (dpy, win, &root, &wi, &children, &nchildren))
907 XFree (children);
908 else
909 break;
910 }
911
912 return win;
913 }
914
915 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
916
917 void
918 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
919 {
920 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
921 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
922 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
923 double alpha = 1.0;
924 double alpha_min = 1.0;
925 unsigned long opac;
926 Window parent;
927
928 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
929 alpha = f->alpha[0];
930 else
931 alpha = f->alpha[1];
932
933 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
934 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
935 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
936 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
937
938 if (alpha < 0.0)
939 return;
940 else if (alpha > 1.0)
941 alpha = 1.0;
942 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
943 alpha = alpha_min;
944
945 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
946
947 x_catch_errors (dpy);
948
949 /* If there is a parent from the window manager, put the property there
950 also, to work around broken window managers that fail to do that.
951 Do this unconditionally as this function is called on reparent when
952 alpha has not changed on the frame. */
953
954 parent = x_find_topmost_parent (f);
955 if (parent != None)
956 XChangeProperty (dpy, parent, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
957 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
958 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1);
959
960 /* return unless necessary */
961 {
962 unsigned char *data;
963 Atom actual;
964 int rc, format;
965 unsigned long n, left;
966
967 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
968 0, 1, False, XA_CARDINAL,
969 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
970 &data);
971
972 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
973 {
974 unsigned long value = *(unsigned long *)data;
975 XFree (data);
976 if (value == opac)
977 {
978 x_uncatch_errors ();
979 return;
980 }
981 }
982 }
983
984 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
985 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
986 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1);
987 x_uncatch_errors ();
988 }
989
990 /***********************************************************************
991 Starting and ending an update
992 ***********************************************************************/
993
994 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
995 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
996 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
997 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
998 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
999
1000 static void
1001 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
1002 {
1003 #ifdef USE_CAIRO
1004 if (! NILP (tip_frame) && XFRAME (tip_frame) == f
1005 && ! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
1006 return;
1007
1008 if (! FRAME_CR_SURFACE (f))
1009 {
1010 int width, height;
1011 #ifdef USE_GTK
1012 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
1013 {
1014 GdkWindow *w = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
1015 width = gdk_window_get_width (w);
1016 height = gdk_window_get_height (w);
1017 }
1018 else
1019 #endif
1020 {
1021 width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
1022 height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
1023 if (! FRAME_EXTERNAL_TOOL_BAR (f))
1024 height += FRAME_TOOL_BAR_HEIGHT (f);
1025 if (! FRAME_EXTERNAL_MENU_BAR (f))
1026 height += FRAME_MENU_BAR_HEIGHT (f);
1027 }
1028
1029 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
1030 {
1031 block_input();
1032 FRAME_CR_SURFACE (f) = cairo_image_surface_create
1033 (CAIRO_FORMAT_ARGB32, width, height);
1034 unblock_input();
1035 }
1036 }
1037 #endif /* USE_CAIRO */
1038 }
1039
1040 /* Start update of window W. */
1041
1042 static void
1043 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
1044 {
1045 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
1046 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
1047
1048 w->output_cursor = w->cursor;
1049
1050 block_input ();
1051
1052 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
1053 {
1054 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
1055 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = true;
1056
1057 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
1058 highlighting. */
1059 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
1060 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
1061 }
1062
1063 unblock_input ();
1064 }
1065
1066
1067 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
1068
1069 static void
1070 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
1071 {
1072 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
1073 struct face *face;
1074
1075 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
1076 if (face)
1077 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
1078 face->foreground);
1079
1080 #ifdef USE_CAIRO
1081 x_fill_rectangle (f, f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, 1, y1 - y0);
1082 #else
1083 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
1084 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
1085 #endif
1086 }
1087
1088 /* Draw a window divider from (x0,y0) to (x1,y1) */
1089
1090 static void
1091 x_draw_window_divider (struct window *w, int x0, int x1, int y0, int y1)
1092 {
1093 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
1094 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, WINDOW_DIVIDER_FACE_ID);
1095 struct face *face_first = FACE_FROM_ID (f, WINDOW_DIVIDER_FIRST_PIXEL_FACE_ID);
1096 struct face *face_last = FACE_FROM_ID (f, WINDOW_DIVIDER_LAST_PIXEL_FACE_ID);
1097 unsigned long color = face ? face->foreground : FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f);
1098 unsigned long color_first = (face_first
1099 ? face_first->foreground
1100 : FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
1101 unsigned long color_last = (face_last
1102 ? face_last->foreground
1103 : FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
1104 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1105
1106 if (y1 - y0 > x1 - x0 && x1 - x0 > 2)
1107 /* Vertical. */
1108 {
1109 XSetForeground (display, f->output_data.x->normal_gc, color_first);
1110 x_fill_rectangle (f, f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
1111 x0, y0, 1, y1 - y0);
1112 XSetForeground (display, f->output_data.x->normal_gc, color);
1113 x_fill_rectangle (f, f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
1114 x0 + 1, y0, x1 - x0 - 2, y1 - y0);
1115 XSetForeground (display, f->output_data.x->normal_gc, color_last);
1116 x_fill_rectangle (f, f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
1117 x1 - 1, y0, 1, y1 - y0);
1118 }
1119 else if (x1 - x0 > y1 - y0 && y1 - y0 > 3)
1120 /* Horizontal. */
1121 {
1122 XSetForeground (display, f->output_data.x->normal_gc, color_first);
1123 x_fill_rectangle (f, f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
1124 x0, y0, x1 - x0, 1);
1125 XSetForeground (display, f->output_data.x->normal_gc, color);
1126 x_fill_rectangle (f, f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
1127 x0, y0 + 1, x1 - x0, y1 - y0 - 2);
1128 XSetForeground (display, f->output_data.x->normal_gc, color_last);
1129 x_fill_rectangle (f, f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
1130 x0, y1 - 1, x1 - x0, 1);
1131 }
1132 else
1133 {
1134 XSetForeground (display, f->output_data.x->normal_gc, color);
1135 x_fill_rectangle (f, f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
1136 x0, y0, x1 - x0, y1 - y0);
1137 }
1138 }
1139
1140 /* End update of window W.
1141
1142 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
1143 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
1144
1145 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
1146 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
1147 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
1148
1149 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
1150 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
1151 here. */
1152
1153 static void
1154 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, bool cursor_on_p,
1155 bool mouse_face_overwritten_p)
1156 {
1157 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
1158 {
1159 block_input ();
1160
1161 if (cursor_on_p)
1162 display_and_set_cursor (w, true,
1163 w->output_cursor.hpos, w->output_cursor.vpos,
1164 w->output_cursor.x, w->output_cursor.y);
1165
1166 if (draw_window_fringes (w, true))
1167 {
1168 if (WINDOW_RIGHT_DIVIDER_WIDTH (w))
1169 x_draw_right_divider (w);
1170 else
1171 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
1172 }
1173
1174 unblock_input ();
1175 }
1176
1177 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
1178 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
1179 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
1180 {
1181 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
1182
1183 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
1184 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
1185 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
1186 }
1187 }
1188
1189
1190 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
1191 update_end. */
1192
1193 static void
1194 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
1195 {
1196 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
1197 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = false;
1198
1199 #ifdef USE_CAIRO
1200 if (FRAME_CR_SURFACE (f))
1201 {
1202 cairo_t *cr = 0;
1203 block_input();
1204 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (HAVE_GTK3)
1205 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
1206 {
1207 GdkWindow *w = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
1208 cr = gdk_cairo_create (w);
1209 }
1210 else
1211 #endif
1212 {
1213 cairo_surface_t *surface;
1214 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
1215 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
1216 if (! FRAME_EXTERNAL_TOOL_BAR (f))
1217 height += FRAME_TOOL_BAR_HEIGHT (f);
1218 if (! FRAME_EXTERNAL_MENU_BAR (f))
1219 height += FRAME_MENU_BAR_HEIGHT (f);
1220 surface = cairo_xlib_surface_create (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
1221 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
1222 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->visual,
1223 width,
1224 height);
1225 cr = cairo_create (surface);
1226 cairo_surface_destroy (surface);
1227 }
1228
1229 cairo_set_source_surface (cr, FRAME_CR_SURFACE (f), 0, 0);
1230 cairo_paint (cr);
1231 cairo_destroy (cr);
1232 unblock_input ();
1233 }
1234 #endif /* USE_CAIRO */
1235
1236 #ifndef XFlush
1237 block_input ();
1238 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
1239 unblock_input ();
1240 #endif
1241 }
1242
1243
1244 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c
1245 whenever a complete update has been performed. */
1246
1247 static void
1248 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
1249 {
1250 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
1251 FRAME_MOUSE_UPDATE (f);
1252 }
1253
1254
1255 /* Clear under internal border if any (GTK has its own version). */
1256 #ifndef USE_GTK
1257 void
1258 x_clear_under_internal_border (struct frame *f)
1259 {
1260 if (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f) > 0)
1261 {
1262 int border = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
1263 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
1264 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
1265 int margin = FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f);
1266
1267 block_input ();
1268 x_clear_area (f, 0, 0, border, height);
1269 x_clear_area (f, 0, margin, width, border);
1270 x_clear_area (f, width - border, 0, border, height);
1271 x_clear_area (f, 0, height - border, width, border);
1272 unblock_input ();
1273 }
1274 }
1275 #endif
1276
1277 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
1278 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
1279 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. This function is called from
1280 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
1281 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
1282
1283 static void
1284 x_after_update_window_line (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *desired_row)
1285 {
1286 eassert (w);
1287
1288 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
1289 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = true;
1290
1291 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1292 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
1293 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
1294 check here if updated window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
1295 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
1296 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
1297 overhead is very small. */
1298 {
1299 struct frame *f;
1300 int width, height;
1301
1302 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
1303 && desired_row->full_width_p
1304 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
1305 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
1306 width != 0)
1307 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
1308 height > 0))
1309 {
1310 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
1311
1312 block_input ();
1313 x_clear_area (f, 0, y, width, height);
1314 x_clear_area (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width, y, width, height);
1315 unblock_input ();
1316 }
1317 }
1318 #endif
1319 }
1320
1321 static void
1322 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
1323 {
1324 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
1325 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1326 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
1327 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
1328 struct face *face = p->face;
1329
1330 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
1331 x_clip_to_row (w, row, ANY_AREA, gc);
1332
1333 if (p->bx >= 0 && !p->overlay_p)
1334 {
1335 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
1336 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
1337 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
1338 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
1339 if (face->stipple)
1340 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1341 else
1342 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
1343
1344 x_fill_rectangle (f, face->gc, p->bx, p->by, p->nx, p->ny);
1345
1346 if (!face->stipple)
1347 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
1348 }
1349
1350 #ifdef USE_CAIRO
1351 if (p->which && p->which < max_fringe_bmp)
1352 {
1353 XGCValues gcv;
1354
1355 XGetGCValues (display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &gcv);
1356 XSetForeground (display, gc, (p->cursor_p
1357 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
1358 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
1359 : face->foreground));
1360 XSetBackground (display, gc, face->background);
1361 x_cr_draw_image (f, gc, fringe_bmp[p->which], 0, p->dh,
1362 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y, p->overlay_p);
1363 XSetForeground (display, gc, gcv.foreground);
1364 XSetBackground (display, gc, gcv.background);
1365 }
1366 #else /* not USE_CAIRO */
1367 if (p->which)
1368 {
1369 char *bits;
1370 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
1371 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
1372 XGCValues gcv;
1373
1374 if (p->wd > 8)
1375 bits = (char *) (p->bits + p->dh);
1376 else
1377 bits = (char *) p->bits + p->dh;
1378
1379 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
1380 by the server. */
1381 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
1382 (p->cursor_p
1383 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
1384 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
1385 : face->foreground),
1386 face->background, depth);
1387
1388 if (p->overlay_p)
1389 {
1390 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
1391 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
1392 bits, p->wd, p->h,
1393 1, 0, 1);
1394 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
1395 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
1396 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
1397 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
1398 }
1399
1400 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
1401 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
1402 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
1403
1404 if (p->overlay_p)
1405 {
1406 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
1407 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
1408 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
1409 }
1410 }
1411 #endif /* not USE_CAIRO */
1412
1413 x_reset_clip_rectangles (f, gc);
1414 }
1415
1416 /***********************************************************************
1417 Glyph display
1418 ***********************************************************************/
1419
1420
1421
1422 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
1423 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
1424 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
1425 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
1426 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
1427 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
1428 static _Noreturn void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *, int);
1429 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
1430 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
1431 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
1432 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
1433 static bool x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
1434 unsigned long *, double, int);
1435 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
1436 double, int, unsigned long);
1437 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
1438 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
1439 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
1440 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
1441 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
1442 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
1443 int, int, int);
1444 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
1445 int, bool, bool, bool, bool, bool,
1446 XRectangle *);
1447 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
1448 int, bool, bool, XRectangle *);
1449 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
1450
1451 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
1452 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
1453 #endif
1454
1455
1456 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
1457 face. */
1458
1459 static void
1460 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1461 {
1462 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
1463 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1464 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1465 && !s->cmp)
1466 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
1467 else
1468 {
1469 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
1470 XGCValues xgcv;
1471 unsigned long mask;
1472
1473 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
1474 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1475
1476 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
1477 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1478 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1479 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1480 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
1481 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1482 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1483
1484 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
1485 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
1486 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
1487 {
1488 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
1489 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1490 }
1491
1492 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1493 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1494 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
1495
1496 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1497 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1498 mask, &xgcv);
1499 else
1500 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1501 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1502
1503 s->gc = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1504 }
1505 }
1506
1507
1508 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
1509
1510 static void
1511 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1512 {
1513 int face_id;
1514 struct face *face;
1515
1516 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1517 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1518 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1519 if (face == NULL)
1520 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1521
1522 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1523 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
1524 else
1525 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
1526 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1527 prepare_face_for_display (s->f, s->face);
1528
1529 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1530 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1531 else
1532 {
1533 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1534 except for FONT. */
1535 XGCValues xgcv;
1536 unsigned long mask;
1537
1538 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1539 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1540 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1541 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
1542
1543 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1544 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1545 mask, &xgcv);
1546 else
1547 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1548 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1549
1550 s->gc = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1551
1552 }
1553 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1554 }
1555
1556
1557 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1558 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1559 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1560
1561 static void
1562 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1563 {
1564 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1565 }
1566
1567
1568 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1569 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1570 pattern. */
1571
1572 static void
1573 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1574 {
1575 prepare_face_for_display (s->f, s->face);
1576
1577 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1578 {
1579 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1580 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1581 }
1582 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1583 {
1584 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1585 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1586 }
1587 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1588 {
1589 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1590 s->stippled_p = false;
1591 }
1592 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1593 {
1594 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1595 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1596 }
1597 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1598 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1599 {
1600 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1601 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1602 }
1603 else
1604 emacs_abort ();
1605
1606 /* GC must have been set. */
1607 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1608 }
1609
1610
1611 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1612 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1613
1614 static void
1615 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1616 {
1617 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1618 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1619
1620 if (n > 0)
1621 x_set_clip_rectangles (s->f, s->gc, r, n);
1622 s->num_clips = n;
1623 }
1624
1625
1626 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1627 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1628 the area of SRC. */
1629
1630 static void
1631 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1632 {
1633 XRectangle r;
1634
1635 r.x = src->x;
1636 r.width = src->width;
1637 r.y = src->y;
1638 r.height = src->height;
1639 dst->clip[0] = r;
1640 dst->num_clips = 1;
1641 x_set_clip_rectangles (dst->f, dst->gc, &r, 1);
1642 }
1643
1644
1645 /* RIF:
1646 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1647
1648 static void
1649 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1650 {
1651 if (s->cmp == NULL
1652 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1653 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1654 {
1655 struct font_metrics metrics;
1656
1657 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1658 {
1659 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1660 struct font *font = s->font;
1661 int i;
1662
1663 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1664 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1665 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1666 }
1667 else
1668 {
1669 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1670
1671 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1672 }
1673 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1674 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1675 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1676 }
1677 else if (s->cmp)
1678 {
1679 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1680 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1681 }
1682 }
1683
1684
1685 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1686
1687 static void
1688 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1689 {
1690 XGCValues xgcv;
1691 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1692 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1693 x_fill_rectangle (s->f, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1694 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1695 }
1696
1697
1698 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1699 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1700 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1701 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1702 contains the first component of a composition. */
1703
1704 static void
1705 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, bool force_p)
1706 {
1707 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1708 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1709 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1710 {
1711 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1712
1713 if (s->stippled_p)
1714 {
1715 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1716 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1717 x_fill_rectangle (s->f, s->gc, s->x,
1718 s->y + box_line_width,
1719 s->background_width,
1720 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1721 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1722 s->background_filled_p = true;
1723 }
1724 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1725 /* When xdisp.c ignores FONT_HEIGHT, we cannot trust
1726 font dimensions, since the actual glyphs might be
1727 much smaller. So in that case we always clear the
1728 rectangle with background color. */
1729 || FONT_TOO_HIGH (s->font)
1730 || s->font_not_found_p
1731 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1732 || force_p)
1733 {
1734 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1735 s->background_width,
1736 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1737 s->background_filled_p = true;
1738 }
1739 }
1740 }
1741
1742
1743 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1744
1745 static void
1746 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1747 {
1748 int i, x;
1749
1750 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1751 of S to the right of that box line. */
1752 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1753 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1754 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1755 else
1756 x = s->x;
1757
1758 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1759 loaded. */
1760 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1761 {
1762 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1763 {
1764 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1765 x_draw_rectangle (s->f,
1766 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1767 s->height - 1);
1768 x += g->pixel_width;
1769 }
1770 }
1771 else
1772 {
1773 struct font *font = s->font;
1774 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1775 int y;
1776
1777 if (font->vertical_centering)
1778 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1779
1780 y = s->ybase - boff;
1781 if (s->for_overlaps
1782 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1783 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, false);
1784 else
1785 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, true);
1786 if (s->face->overstrike)
1787 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, false);
1788 }
1789 }
1790
1791 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1792
1793 static void
1794 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1795 {
1796 int i, j, x;
1797 struct font *font = s->font;
1798
1799 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1800 of S to the right of that box line. */
1801 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1802 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1803 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1804 else
1805 x = s->x;
1806
1807 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1808 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1809 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1810 this composition. */
1811
1812 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1813 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1814 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1815 {
1816 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1817 x_draw_rectangle (s->f, s->gc, x, s->y,
1818 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1819 }
1820 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1821 {
1822 int y = s->ybase;
1823
1824 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1825 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding
1826 space on the left or right. */
1827 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1828 {
1829 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1830 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1831
1832 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, false);
1833 if (s->face->overstrike)
1834 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, false);
1835 }
1836 }
1837 else
1838 {
1839 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1840 Lisp_Object glyph;
1841 int y = s->ybase;
1842 int width = 0;
1843
1844 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1845 {
1846 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1847 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1848 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1849 else
1850 {
1851 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1852
1853 if (j < i)
1854 {
1855 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, false);
1856 if (s->face->overstrike)
1857 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, false);
1858 x += width;
1859 }
1860 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1861 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1862 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1863 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, false);
1864 if (s->face->overstrike)
1865 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff,
1866 false);
1867 x += wadjust;
1868 j = i + 1;
1869 width = 0;
1870 }
1871 }
1872 if (j < i)
1873 {
1874 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, false);
1875 if (s->face->overstrike)
1876 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, false);
1877 }
1878 }
1879 }
1880
1881
1882 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1883
1884 static void
1885 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1886 {
1887 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1888 XChar2b char2b[8];
1889 int x, i, j;
1890
1891 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1892 of S to the right of that box line. */
1893 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1894 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1895 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1896 else
1897 x = s->x;
1898
1899 s->char2b = char2b;
1900
1901 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1902 {
1903 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1904 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1905
1906 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1907 {
1908 if (len > 0
1909 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1910 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1911 >= 1))
1912 {
1913 Lisp_Object acronym
1914 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1915 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1916 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1917 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1918 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1919 str = SSDATA (acronym);
1920 }
1921 }
1922 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1923 {
1924 sprintf (buf, "%0*X",
1925 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1926 glyph->u.glyphless.ch + 0u);
1927 str = buf;
1928 }
1929
1930 if (str)
1931 {
1932 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1933 unsigned code;
1934
1935 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1936 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1937 {
1938 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1939 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1940 }
1941 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1942 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1943 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1944 false);
1945 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1946 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1947 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1948 false);
1949 }
1950 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1951 x_draw_rectangle (s->f, s->gc,
1952 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1953 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1954 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1955 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1956 }
1957 }
1958
1959 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1960
1961 #ifdef USE_LUCID
1962
1963 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1964 cannot be determined. */
1965
1966 static struct frame *
1967 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1968 {
1969 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1970 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
1971 struct frame *f;
1972
1973 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1974
1975 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1976 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1977 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1978 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1979 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1980 widget = XtParent (widget);
1981
1982 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1983 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1984 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
1985 {
1986 f = XFRAME (frame);
1987 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
1988 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1989 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo
1990 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1991 return f;
1992 }
1993 emacs_abort ();
1994 }
1995
1996 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1997 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1998 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1999 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
2000 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
2001 Value is true if successful. */
2002
2003 bool
2004 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
2005 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
2006 {
2007 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
2008 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
2009 }
2010
2011 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
2012
2013
2014 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
2015 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
2016
2017 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
2018 {
2019 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) offsetof (WidgetRec, core.screen),
2020 sizeof (Screen *)},
2021 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) offsetof (WidgetRec, core.colormap),
2022 sizeof (Colormap)}
2023 };
2024
2025
2026 /* The address of this variable is returned by
2027 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
2028
2029 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
2030
2031
2032 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
2033
2034 DPY is the display we are working on.
2035
2036 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
2037 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
2038 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
2039 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
2040
2041 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
2042 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
2043
2044 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
2045 we allocated the color or not.
2046
2047 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
2048
2049 static Boolean
2050 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
2051 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
2052 XtPointer *closure_ret)
2053 {
2054 Screen *screen;
2055 Colormap cmap;
2056 Pixel pixel;
2057 String color_name;
2058 XColor color;
2059
2060 if (*nargs != 2)
2061 {
2062 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
2063 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
2064 "XtToolkitError",
2065 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
2066 return False;
2067 }
2068
2069 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
2070 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
2071 color_name = (String) from->addr;
2072
2073 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
2074 {
2075 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
2076 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
2077 }
2078 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
2079 {
2080 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
2081 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
2082 }
2083 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
2084 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
2085 {
2086 pixel = color.pixel;
2087 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
2088 }
2089 else
2090 {
2091 String params[1];
2092 Cardinal nparams = 1;
2093
2094 params[0] = color_name;
2095 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
2096 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
2097 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color '%s'",
2098 params, &nparams);
2099 return False;
2100 }
2101
2102 if (to->addr != NULL)
2103 {
2104 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
2105 {
2106 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
2107 return False;
2108 }
2109
2110 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
2111 }
2112 else
2113 {
2114 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
2115 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
2116 }
2117
2118 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
2119 return True;
2120 }
2121
2122
2123 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
2124 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
2125 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
2126
2127 APP is the application context in which we work.
2128
2129 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
2130 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
2131 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
2132
2133 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
2134
2135 static void
2136 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
2137 Cardinal *nargs)
2138 {
2139 if (*nargs != 2)
2140 {
2141 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
2142 "XtToolkitError",
2143 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
2144 NULL, NULL);
2145 }
2146 else if (closure != NULL)
2147 {
2148 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
2149 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
2150 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
2151 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
2152 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
2153 }
2154 }
2155
2156
2157 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
2158
2159
2160 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
2161 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
2162 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
2163 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
2164
2165 static const XColor *
2166 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
2167 {
2168 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
2169
2170 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
2171 {
2172 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
2173 int ncolor_cells = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
2174 int i;
2175
2176 dpyinfo->color_cells = xnmalloc (ncolor_cells,
2177 sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
2178 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = ncolor_cells;
2179
2180 for (i = 0; i < ncolor_cells; ++i)
2181 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
2182
2183 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
2184 dpyinfo->color_cells, ncolor_cells);
2185 }
2186
2187 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
2188 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
2189 }
2190
2191
2192 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
2193 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
2194
2195 void
2196 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
2197 {
2198 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
2199
2200 if (dpyinfo->red_bits > 0)
2201 {
2202 /* For TrueColor displays, we can decompose the RGB value
2203 directly. */
2204 int i;
2205 unsigned int rmult, gmult, bmult;
2206 unsigned int rmask, gmask, bmask;
2207
2208 rmask = (1 << dpyinfo->red_bits) - 1;
2209 gmask = (1 << dpyinfo->green_bits) - 1;
2210 bmask = (1 << dpyinfo->blue_bits) - 1;
2211 /* If we're widening, for example, 8 bits in the pixel value to
2212 16 bits for the separate-color representation, we want to
2213 extrapolate the lower bits based on those bits available --
2214 in other words, we'd like 0xff to become 0xffff instead of
2215 the 0xff00 we'd get by just zero-filling the lower bits.
2216
2217 We generate a 32-bit scaled-up value and shift it, in case
2218 the bit count doesn't divide 16 evently (e.g., when dealing
2219 with a 3-3-2 bit RGB display), to get more of the lower bits
2220 correct.
2221
2222 Should we cache the multipliers in dpyinfo? Maybe
2223 special-case the 8-8-8 common case? */
2224 rmult = 0xffffffff / rmask;
2225 gmult = 0xffffffff / gmask;
2226 bmult = 0xffffffff / bmask;
2227
2228 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
2229 {
2230 unsigned int r, g, b;
2231 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
2232
2233 r = (pixel >> dpyinfo->red_offset) & rmask;
2234 g = (pixel >> dpyinfo->green_offset) & gmask;
2235 b = (pixel >> dpyinfo->blue_offset) & bmask;
2236
2237 colors[i].red = (r * rmult) >> 16;
2238 colors[i].green = (g * gmult) >> 16;
2239 colors[i].blue = (b * bmult) >> 16;
2240 }
2241 return;
2242 }
2243
2244 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
2245 {
2246 int i;
2247 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
2248 {
2249 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
2250 eassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
2251 eassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
2252 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
2253 }
2254 return;
2255 }
2256
2257 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
2258 }
2259
2260
2261 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
2262 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
2263
2264 void
2265 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
2266 {
2267 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
2268 }
2269
2270
2271 /* On frame F, translate the color name to RGB values. Use cached
2272 information, if possible.
2273
2274 Note that there is currently no way to clean old entries out of the
2275 cache. However, it is limited to names in the server's database,
2276 and names we've actually looked up; list-colors-display is probably
2277 the most color-intensive case we're likely to hit. */
2278
2279 Status x_parse_color (struct frame *f, const char *color_name,
2280 XColor *color)
2281 {
2282 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2283 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
2284 struct color_name_cache_entry *cache_entry;
2285
2286 if (color_name[0] == '#')
2287 {
2288 /* The hex form is parsed directly by XParseColor without
2289 talking to the X server. No need for caching. */
2290 return XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, color);
2291 }
2292
2293 for (cache_entry = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->color_names; cache_entry;
2294 cache_entry = cache_entry->next)
2295 {
2296 if (!xstrcasecmp(cache_entry->name, color_name))
2297 {
2298 *color = cache_entry->rgb;
2299 return 1;
2300 }
2301 }
2302
2303 if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, color) == 0)
2304 /* No caching of negative results, currently. */
2305 return 0;
2306
2307 cache_entry = xzalloc (sizeof *cache_entry);
2308 cache_entry->rgb = *color;
2309 cache_entry->name = xstrdup (color_name);
2310 cache_entry->next = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->color_names;
2311 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->color_names = cache_entry;
2312 return 1;
2313 }
2314
2315
2316 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
2317 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
2318 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
2319 allocated. */
2320
2321 static bool
2322 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
2323 {
2324 bool rc;
2325
2326 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color) != 0;
2327 if (rc == 0)
2328 {
2329 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
2330 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
2331 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
2332 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
2333 int nearest, i;
2334 int max_color_delta = 255;
2335 int max_delta = 3 * max_color_delta;
2336 int nearest_delta = max_delta + 1;
2337 int ncells;
2338 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
2339
2340 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
2341 {
2342 int dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
2343 int dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
2344 int dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
2345 int delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
2346
2347 if (delta < nearest_delta)
2348 {
2349 nearest = i;
2350 nearest_delta = delta;
2351 }
2352 }
2353
2354 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
2355 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
2356 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
2357 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color) != 0;
2358 }
2359 else
2360 {
2361 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
2362 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
2363 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
2364 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
2365 XColor *cached_color;
2366
2367 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
2368 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
2369 (cached_color->red != color->red
2370 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
2371 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
2372 {
2373 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
2374 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
2375 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
2376 }
2377 }
2378
2379 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
2380 if (rc)
2381 register_color (color->pixel);
2382 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
2383
2384 return rc;
2385 }
2386
2387
2388 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP, after
2389 gamma correction. If an exact match can't be allocated, try the
2390 nearest color available. Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR
2391 to the color allocated. */
2392
2393 bool
2394 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
2395 {
2396 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
2397
2398 gamma_correct (f, color);
2399
2400 if (dpyinfo->red_bits > 0)
2401 {
2402 color->pixel = x_make_truecolor_pixel (dpyinfo,
2403 color->red,
2404 color->green,
2405 color->blue);
2406 return true;
2407 }
2408
2409 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
2410 }
2411
2412
2413 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
2414 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
2415 get color reference counts right. */
2416
2417 unsigned long
2418 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, unsigned long pixel)
2419 {
2420 XColor color;
2421
2422 /* If display has an immutable color map, freeing colors is not
2423 necessary and some servers don't allow it. Since we won't free a
2424 color once we've allocated it, we don't need to re-allocate it to
2425 maintain the server's reference count. */
2426 if (!x_mutable_colormap (FRAME_X_VISUAL (f)))
2427 return pixel;
2428
2429 color.pixel = pixel;
2430 block_input ();
2431 /* The color could still be found in the color_cells array. */
2432 x_query_color (f, &color);
2433 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
2434 unblock_input ();
2435 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
2436 register_color (pixel);
2437 #endif
2438 return color.pixel;
2439 }
2440
2441
2442 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
2443 boosted.
2444
2445 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
2446 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
2447 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
2448 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
2449 use an additional additive factor.
2450
2451 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
2452 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
2453 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
2454
2455
2456 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
2457 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
2458 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
2459 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
2460 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
2461 Value is non-zero if successful. */
2462
2463 static bool
2464 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
2465 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
2466 {
2467 XColor color, new;
2468 long bright;
2469 bool success_p;
2470
2471 /* Get RGB color values. */
2472 color.pixel = *pixel;
2473 x_query_color (f, &color);
2474
2475 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
2476 eassert (factor >= 0);
2477 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
2478 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
2479 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
2480
2481 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
2482 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
2483
2484 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
2485 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
2486 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
2487 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
2488 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
2489 {
2490 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
2491 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
2492 /* The additive adjustment. */
2493 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
2494
2495 if (factor < 1)
2496 {
2497 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
2498 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
2499 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
2500 }
2501 else
2502 {
2503 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
2504 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
2505 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
2506 }
2507 }
2508
2509 /* Try to allocate the color. */
2510 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
2511 if (success_p)
2512 {
2513 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
2514 {
2515 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
2516 delta to the RGB values. */
2517 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
2518
2519 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
2520 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
2521 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
2522 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
2523 }
2524 else
2525 success_p = true;
2526 *pixel = new.pixel;
2527 }
2528
2529 return success_p;
2530 }
2531
2532
2533 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
2534 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
2535 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
2536 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
2537 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
2538 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
2539
2540 static void
2541 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor,
2542 int delta, unsigned long default_pixel)
2543 {
2544 XGCValues xgcv;
2545 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
2546 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
2547 unsigned long pixel;
2548 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
2549 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
2550 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
2551 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2552
2553 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
2554 xgcv.line_width = 1;
2555
2556 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
2557 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
2558 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
2559 if (relief->gc && relief->pixel != -1)
2560 {
2561 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
2562 relief->pixel = -1;
2563 }
2564
2565 /* Allocate new color. */
2566 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
2567 pixel = background;
2568 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
2569 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
2570 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
2571
2572 if (relief->gc == 0)
2573 {
2574 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
2575 mask |= GCStipple;
2576 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
2577 }
2578 else
2579 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2580 }
2581
2582
2583 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
2584
2585 static void
2586 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
2587 {
2588 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
2589 unsigned long color;
2590
2591 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
2592 color = s->face->box_color;
2593 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
2594 && s->img->pixmap
2595 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
2596 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
2597 else
2598 {
2599 XGCValues xgcv;
2600
2601 /* Get the background color of the face. */
2602 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
2603 color = xgcv.background;
2604 }
2605
2606 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
2607 || color != di->relief_background)
2608 {
2609 di->relief_background = color;
2610 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
2611 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2612 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
2613 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2614 }
2615 }
2616
2617
2618 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
2619 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2620 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P means draw a raised
2621 relief. LEFT_P means draw a relief on the left side of
2622 the rectangle. RIGHT_P means draw a relief on the right
2623 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2624 when drawing. */
2625
2626 static void
2627 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
2628 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y,
2629 int width, bool raised_p, bool top_p, bool bot_p,
2630 bool left_p, bool right_p,
2631 XRectangle *clip_rect)
2632 {
2633 #ifdef USE_CAIRO
2634 GC top_left_gc, bottom_right_gc;
2635 int corners = 0;
2636
2637 if (raised_p)
2638 {
2639 top_left_gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2640 bottom_right_gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2641 }
2642 else
2643 {
2644 top_left_gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2645 bottom_right_gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2646 }
2647
2648 x_set_clip_rectangles (f, top_left_gc, clip_rect, 1);
2649 x_set_clip_rectangles (f, bottom_right_gc, clip_rect, 1);
2650
2651 if (left_p)
2652 {
2653 x_fill_rectangle (f, top_left_gc, left_x, top_y,
2654 width, bottom_y + 1 - top_y);
2655 if (top_p)
2656 corners |= 1 << CORNER_TOP_LEFT;
2657 if (bot_p)
2658 corners |= 1 << CORNER_BOTTOM_LEFT;
2659 }
2660 if (right_p)
2661 {
2662 x_fill_rectangle (f, bottom_right_gc, right_x + 1 - width, top_y,
2663 width, bottom_y + 1 - top_y);
2664 if (top_p)
2665 corners |= 1 << CORNER_TOP_RIGHT;
2666 if (bot_p)
2667 corners |= 1 << CORNER_BOTTOM_RIGHT;
2668 }
2669 if (top_p)
2670 {
2671 if (!right_p)
2672 x_fill_rectangle (f, top_left_gc, left_x, top_y,
2673 right_x + 1 - left_x, width);
2674 else
2675 x_fill_trapezoid_for_relief (f, top_left_gc, left_x, top_y,
2676 right_x + 1 - left_x, width, 1);
2677 }
2678 if (bot_p)
2679 {
2680 if (!left_p)
2681 x_fill_rectangle (f, bottom_right_gc, left_x, bottom_y + 1 - width,
2682 right_x + 1 - left_x, width);
2683 else
2684 x_fill_trapezoid_for_relief (f, bottom_right_gc,
2685 left_x, bottom_y + 1 - width,
2686 right_x + 1 - left_x, width, 0);
2687 }
2688 if (left_p && width != 1)
2689 x_fill_rectangle (f, bottom_right_gc, left_x, top_y,
2690 1, bottom_y + 1 - top_y);
2691 if (top_p && width != 1)
2692 x_fill_rectangle (f, bottom_right_gc, left_x, top_y,
2693 right_x + 1 - left_x, 1);
2694 if (corners)
2695 {
2696 XSetBackground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), top_left_gc,
2697 FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
2698 x_erase_corners_for_relief (f, top_left_gc, left_x, top_y,
2699 right_x - left_x + 1, bottom_y - top_y + 1,
2700 6, 1, corners);
2701 }
2702
2703 x_reset_clip_rectangles (f, top_left_gc);
2704 x_reset_clip_rectangles (f, bottom_right_gc);
2705 #else
2706 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2707 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2708 int i;
2709 GC gc;
2710
2711 if (raised_p)
2712 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2713 else
2714 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2715 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2716
2717 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
2718 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
2719 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
2720 corner pixels. */
2721
2722 /* Top. */
2723 if (top_p)
2724 {
2725 if (width == 1)
2726 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2727 left_x + left_p, top_y,
2728 right_x + !right_p, top_y);
2729
2730 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2731 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2732 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2733 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2734 }
2735
2736 /* Left. */
2737 if (left_p)
2738 {
2739 if (width == 1)
2740 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2741
2742 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2743 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2744
2745 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
2746 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2747 left_x + i, top_y + (i + 1) * top_p,
2748 left_x + i, bottom_y + 1 - (i + 1) * bot_p);
2749 }
2750
2751 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2752 if (raised_p)
2753 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2754 else
2755 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2756 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2757
2758 if (width > 1)
2759 {
2760 /* Outermost top line. */
2761 if (top_p)
2762 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2763 left_x + left_p, top_y,
2764 right_x + !right_p, top_y);
2765
2766 /* Outermost left line. */
2767 if (left_p)
2768 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2769 }
2770
2771 /* Bottom. */
2772 if (bot_p)
2773 {
2774 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2775 left_x + left_p, bottom_y,
2776 right_x + !right_p, bottom_y);
2777 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2778 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2779 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2780 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2781 }
2782
2783 /* Right. */
2784 if (right_p)
2785 {
2786 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2787 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2788 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2789 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2790 right_x - i, top_y + (i + 1) * top_p,
2791 right_x - i, bottom_y + 1 - (i + 1) * bot_p);
2792 }
2793
2794 x_reset_clip_rectangles (f, gc);
2795
2796 #endif
2797 }
2798
2799
2800 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2801 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2802 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P means draw a line on the
2803 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P means draw a line
2804 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2805 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2806
2807 static void
2808 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2809 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2810 bool left_p, bool right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2811 {
2812 XGCValues xgcv;
2813
2814 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2815 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2816 x_set_clip_rectangles (s->f, s->gc, clip_rect, 1);
2817
2818 /* Top. */
2819 x_fill_rectangle (s->f, s->gc,
2820 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2821
2822 /* Left. */
2823 if (left_p)
2824 x_fill_rectangle (s->f, s->gc,
2825 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2826
2827 /* Bottom. */
2828 x_fill_rectangle (s->f, s->gc,
2829 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2830
2831 /* Right. */
2832 if (right_p)
2833 x_fill_rectangle (s->f, s->gc,
2834 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2835
2836 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2837 x_reset_clip_rectangles (s->f, s->gc);
2838 }
2839
2840
2841 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2842
2843 static void
2844 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2845 {
2846 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x;
2847 bool raised_p, left_p, right_p;
2848 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2849 XRectangle clip_rect;
2850
2851 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2852 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2853 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2854
2855 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2856 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2857 ? s->first_glyph
2858 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2859
2860 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2861 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2862 left_x = s->x;
2863 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2864 ? last_x - 1
2865 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2866 top_y = s->y;
2867 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2868
2869 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2870 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2871 && (s->prev == NULL
2872 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2873 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2874 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2875 && (s->next == NULL
2876 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2877
2878 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2879
2880 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2881 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2882 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2883 else
2884 {
2885 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2886 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2887 width, raised_p, true, true, left_p, right_p,
2888 &clip_rect);
2889 }
2890 }
2891
2892
2893 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2894
2895 static void
2896 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2897 {
2898 int x = s->x;
2899 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2900
2901 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2902 right of that line. */
2903 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2904 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2905 && s->slice.x == 0)
2906 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2907
2908 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2909 by that margin. */
2910 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2911 x += s->img->hmargin;
2912 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2913 y += s->img->vmargin;
2914
2915 if (s->img->pixmap)
2916 {
2917 if (s->img->mask)
2918 {
2919 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2920 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2921 trust on the shape extension to be available
2922 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2923 manually. */
2924 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2925 | GCFunction);
2926 XGCValues xgcv;
2927 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2928
2929 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2930 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2931 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2932 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2933 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2934
2935 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2936 image_rect.x = x;
2937 image_rect.y = y;
2938 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2939 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2940 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2941 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2942 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2943 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2944 }
2945 else
2946 {
2947 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2948
2949 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2950 image_rect.x = x;
2951 image_rect.y = y;
2952 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2953 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2954 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2955 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2956 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2957 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2958
2959 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2960 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2961 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2962 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2963 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2964 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2965 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2966 {
2967 int relief = eabs (s->img->relief);
2968 x_draw_rectangle (s->f, s->gc,
2969 x - relief, y - relief,
2970 s->slice.width + relief*2 - 1,
2971 s->slice.height + relief*2 - 1);
2972 }
2973 }
2974 }
2975 else
2976 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2977 x_draw_rectangle (s->f, s->gc, x, y,
2978 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2979 }
2980
2981
2982 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2983
2984 static void
2985 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2986 {
2987 int x1, y1, thick;
2988 bool raised_p, top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p;
2989 int extra_x, extra_y;
2990 XRectangle r;
2991 int x = s->x;
2992 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2993
2994 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2995 right of that line. */
2996 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2997 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2998 && s->slice.x == 0)
2999 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
3000
3001 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
3002 by that margin. */
3003 if (s->slice.x == 0)
3004 x += s->img->hmargin;
3005 if (s->slice.y == 0)
3006 y += s->img->vmargin;
3007
3008 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
3009 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
3010 {
3011 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
3012 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
3013 }
3014 else
3015 {
3016 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
3017 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
3018 }
3019
3020 x1 = x + s->slice.width - 1;
3021 y1 = y + s->slice.height - 1;
3022
3023 extra_x = extra_y = 0;
3024 if (s->face->id == TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID)
3025 {
3026 if (CONSP (Vtool_bar_button_margin)
3027 && INTEGERP (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
3028 && INTEGERP (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)))
3029 {
3030 extra_x = XINT (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
3031 extra_y = XINT (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
3032 }
3033 else if (INTEGERP (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
3034 extra_x = extra_y = XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin);
3035 }
3036
3037 top_p = bot_p = left_p = right_p = false;
3038
3039 if (s->slice.x == 0)
3040 x -= thick + extra_x, left_p = true;
3041 if (s->slice.y == 0)
3042 y -= thick + extra_y, top_p = true;
3043 if (s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width)
3044 x1 += thick + extra_x, right_p = true;
3045 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height)
3046 y1 += thick + extra_y, bot_p = true;
3047
3048 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
3049 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
3050 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x, y, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
3051 top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, &r);
3052 }
3053
3054
3055 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
3056
3057 static void
3058 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
3059 {
3060 int x = 0;
3061 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
3062
3063 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
3064 right of that line. */
3065 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
3066 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
3067 && s->slice.x == 0)
3068 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
3069
3070 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
3071 by that margin. */
3072 if (s->slice.x == 0)
3073 x += s->img->hmargin;
3074 if (s->slice.y == 0)
3075 y += s->img->vmargin;
3076
3077 if (s->img->pixmap)
3078 {
3079 if (s->img->mask)
3080 {
3081 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
3082 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
3083 trust on the shape extension to be available
3084 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
3085 manually. */
3086 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
3087 | GCFunction);
3088 XGCValues xgcv;
3089
3090 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
3091 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
3092 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
3093 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
3094 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
3095
3096 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
3097 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
3098 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
3099 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
3100 }
3101 else
3102 {
3103 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
3104 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
3105 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
3106
3107 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
3108 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
3109 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
3110 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
3111 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
3112 nothing here for mouse-face. */
3113 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
3114 {
3115 int r = eabs (s->img->relief);
3116 x_draw_rectangle (s->f, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
3117 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
3118 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
3119 }
3120 }
3121 }
3122 else
3123 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
3124 x_draw_rectangle (s->f, s->gc, x, y,
3125 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
3126 }
3127
3128
3129 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
3130 give the rectangle to draw. */
3131
3132 static void
3133 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
3134 {
3135 if (s->stippled_p)
3136 {
3137 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
3138 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
3139 x_fill_rectangle (s->f, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
3140 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
3141 }
3142 else
3143 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
3144 }
3145
3146
3147 /* Draw image glyph string S.
3148
3149 s->y
3150 s->x +-------------------------
3151 | s->face->box
3152 |
3153 | +-------------------------
3154 | | s->img->margin
3155 | |
3156 | | +-------------------
3157 | | | the image
3158
3159 */
3160
3161 static void
3162 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
3163 {
3164 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
3165 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
3166 int height;
3167 Pixmap pixmap = None;
3168
3169 height = s->height;
3170 if (s->slice.y == 0)
3171 height -= box_line_vwidth;
3172 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
3173 height -= box_line_vwidth;
3174
3175 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
3176 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
3177 flickering. */
3178 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
3179 if (height > s->slice.height
3180 || s->img->hmargin
3181 || s->img->vmargin
3182 || s->img->mask
3183 || s->img->pixmap == 0
3184 || s->width != s->background_width)
3185 {
3186 if (s->img->mask)
3187 {
3188 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
3189 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
3190 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
3191 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
3192 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
3193
3194 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
3195 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
3196 s->background_width,
3197 s->height, depth);
3198
3199 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
3200 pixmap. */
3201 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
3202
3203 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
3204 if (s->stippled_p)
3205 {
3206 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
3207 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
3208 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
3209 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
3210 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
3211 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
3212 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
3213 }
3214 else
3215 {
3216 XGCValues xgcv;
3217 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
3218 &xgcv);
3219 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
3220 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
3221 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
3222 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
3223 }
3224 }
3225 else
3226 {
3227 int x = s->x;
3228 int y = s->y;
3229 int width = s->background_width;
3230
3231 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
3232 && s->slice.x == 0)
3233 {
3234 x += box_line_hwidth;
3235 width -= box_line_hwidth;
3236 }
3237
3238 if (s->slice.y == 0)
3239 y += box_line_vwidth;
3240
3241 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, width, height);
3242 }
3243
3244 s->background_filled_p = true;
3245 }
3246
3247 /* Draw the foreground. */
3248 #ifdef USE_CAIRO
3249 if (s->img->cr_data)
3250 {
3251 cairo_t *cr = x_begin_cr_clip (s->f, s->gc);
3252
3253 int x = s->x + s->img->hmargin;
3254 int y = s->y + s->img->vmargin;
3255 int width = s->background_width;
3256
3257 cairo_set_source_surface (cr, s->img->cr_data,
3258 x - s->slice.x,
3259 y - s->slice.y);
3260 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, width, height);
3261 cairo_fill (cr);
3262 x_end_cr_clip (s->f);
3263 }
3264 else
3265 #endif
3266 if (pixmap != None)
3267 {
3268 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
3269 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
3270 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
3271 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
3272 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
3273 }
3274 else
3275 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
3276
3277 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
3278 if (s->img->relief
3279 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
3280 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
3281 x_draw_image_relief (s);
3282 }
3283
3284
3285 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
3286
3287 static void
3288 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
3289 {
3290 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
3291
3292 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
3293 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
3294 {
3295 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
3296 wide as the stretch glyph. */
3297 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
3298 int x = s->x;
3299
3300 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
3301 {
3302 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
3303
3304 if (x < left_x)
3305 {
3306 background_width -= left_x - x;
3307 x = left_x;
3308 }
3309 }
3310 else
3311 {
3312 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
3313 stretch glyph. */
3314 int right_x = window_box_right (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
3315
3316 if (x + background_width > right_x)
3317 background_width -= x - right_x;
3318 x += background_width;
3319 }
3320 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
3321 if (s->row->reversed_p)
3322 x -= width;
3323
3324 /* Draw cursor. */
3325 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
3326
3327 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
3328 if (width < background_width)
3329 {
3330 int y = s->y;
3331 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
3332 XRectangle r;
3333 GC gc;
3334
3335 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
3336 x += width;
3337 else
3338 x = s->x;
3339 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
3340 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
3341 {
3342 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
3343 gc = s->gc;
3344 }
3345 else
3346 gc = s->face->gc;
3347
3348 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
3349 x_set_clip_rectangles (s->f, gc, &r, 1);
3350
3351 if (s->face->stipple)
3352 {
3353 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
3354 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
3355 x_fill_rectangle (s->f, gc, x, y, w, h);
3356 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
3357 }
3358 else
3359 {
3360 XGCValues xgcv;
3361 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
3362 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
3363 x_fill_rectangle (s->f, gc, x, y, w, h);
3364 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
3365 }
3366
3367 x_reset_clip_rectangles (s->f, gc);
3368 }
3369 }
3370 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
3371 {
3372 int background_width = s->background_width;
3373 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
3374
3375 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
3376 except for header line and mode line. */
3377 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
3378 {
3379 background_width -= left_x - x;
3380 x = left_x;
3381 }
3382 if (background_width > 0)
3383 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
3384 }
3385
3386 s->background_filled_p = true;
3387 }
3388
3389 /*
3390 Draw a wavy line under S. The wave fills wave_height pixels from y0.
3391
3392 x0 wave_length = 2
3393 --
3394 y0 * * * * *
3395 |* * * * * * * * *
3396 wave_height = 3 | * * * *
3397
3398 */
3399
3400 static void
3401 x_draw_underwave (struct glyph_string *s)
3402 {
3403 int wave_height = 3, wave_length = 2;
3404 #ifdef USE_CAIRO
3405 x_draw_horizontal_wave (s->f, s->gc, s->x, s->ybase - wave_height + 3,
3406 s->width, wave_height, wave_length);
3407 #else /* not USE_CAIRO */
3408 int dx, dy, x0, y0, width, x1, y1, x2, y2, xmax;
3409 bool odd;
3410 XRectangle wave_clip, string_clip, final_clip;
3411
3412 dx = wave_length;
3413 dy = wave_height - 1;
3414 x0 = s->x;
3415 y0 = s->ybase - wave_height + 3;
3416 width = s->width;
3417 xmax = x0 + width;
3418
3419 /* Find and set clipping rectangle */
3420
3421 wave_clip.x = x0;
3422 wave_clip.y = y0;
3423 wave_clip.width = width;
3424 wave_clip.height = wave_height;
3425 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &string_clip);
3426
3427 if (!x_intersect_rectangles (&wave_clip, &string_clip, &final_clip))
3428 return;
3429
3430 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &final_clip, 1, Unsorted);
3431
3432 /* Draw the waves */
3433
3434 x1 = x0 - (x0 % dx);
3435 x2 = x1 + dx;
3436 odd = (x1 / dx) & 1;
3437 y1 = y2 = y0;
3438
3439 if (odd)
3440 y1 += dy;
3441 else
3442 y2 += dy;
3443
3444 if (INT_MAX - dx < xmax)
3445 emacs_abort ();
3446
3447 while (x1 <= xmax)
3448 {
3449 XDrawLine (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x1, y1, x2, y2);
3450 x1 = x2, y1 = y2;
3451 x2 += dx, y2 = y0 + odd*dy;
3452 odd = !odd;
3453 }
3454
3455 /* Restore previous clipping rectangle(s) */
3456 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, s->clip, s->num_clips, Unsorted);
3457 #endif /* not USE_CAIRO */
3458 }
3459
3460
3461 /* Draw glyph string S. */
3462
3463 static void
3464 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
3465 {
3466 bool relief_drawn_p = false;
3467
3468 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
3469 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
3470 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
3471 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
3472 {
3473 int width;
3474 struct glyph_string *next;
3475
3476 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
3477 next && width < s->right_overhang;
3478 width += next->width, next = next->next)
3479 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
3480 {
3481 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
3482 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
3483 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
3484 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
3485 else
3486 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, true);
3487 next->num_clips = 0;
3488 }
3489 }
3490
3491 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
3492 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
3493
3494 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
3495 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
3496 if (!s->for_overlaps
3497 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
3498 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
3499 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
3500
3501 {
3502 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
3503 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, true);
3504 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
3505 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
3506 relief_drawn_p = true;
3507 }
3508 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
3509 && !s->clip_tail
3510 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
3511 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
3512 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
3513 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
3514 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
3515 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
3516 else
3517 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
3518
3519 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
3520 {
3521 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
3522 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
3523 break;
3524
3525 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
3526 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
3527 break;
3528
3529 case CHAR_GLYPH:
3530 if (s->for_overlaps)
3531 s->background_filled_p = true;
3532 else
3533 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, false);
3534 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
3535 break;
3536
3537 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
3538 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
3539 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
3540 s->background_filled_p = true;
3541 else
3542 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, true);
3543 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
3544 break;
3545
3546 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
3547 if (s->for_overlaps)
3548 s->background_filled_p = true;
3549 else
3550 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, true);
3551 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
3552 break;
3553
3554 default:
3555 emacs_abort ();
3556 }
3557
3558 if (!s->for_overlaps)
3559 {
3560 /* Draw underline. */
3561 if (s->face->underline_p)
3562 {
3563 if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_WAVE)
3564 {
3565 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
3566 x_draw_underwave (s);
3567 else
3568 {
3569 XGCValues xgcv;
3570 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
3571 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
3572 x_draw_underwave (s);
3573 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
3574 }
3575 }
3576 else if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_LINE)
3577 {
3578 unsigned long thickness, position;
3579 int y;
3580
3581 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p
3582 && s->prev->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_LINE)
3583 {
3584 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
3585 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
3586 position = s->prev->underline_position;
3587 }
3588 else
3589 {
3590 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
3591 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
3592 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
3593 else
3594 thickness = 1;
3595 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
3596 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
3597 else
3598 {
3599 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
3600 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
3601 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
3602 specs, and its default is
3603
3604 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
3605 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
3606
3607 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
3608 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
3609 position = s->font->underline_position;
3610 else if (s->font)
3611 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
3612 else
3613 position = underline_minimum_offset;
3614 }
3615 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
3616 }
3617 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
3618 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
3619 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
3620 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
3621 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
3622 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
3623 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
3624 s->underline_position = position;
3625 y = s->ybase + position;
3626 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
3627 x_fill_rectangle (s->f, s->gc,
3628 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
3629 else
3630 {
3631 XGCValues xgcv;
3632 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
3633 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
3634 x_fill_rectangle (s->f, s->gc,
3635 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
3636 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
3637 }
3638 }
3639 }
3640 /* Draw overline. */
3641 if (s->face->overline_p)
3642 {
3643 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
3644
3645 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
3646 x_fill_rectangle (s->f, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
3647 s->width, h);
3648 else
3649 {
3650 XGCValues xgcv;
3651 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
3652 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
3653 x_fill_rectangle (s->f, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
3654 s->width, h);
3655 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
3656 }
3657 }
3658
3659 /* Draw strike-through. */
3660 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
3661 {
3662 unsigned long h = 1;
3663 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
3664
3665 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
3666 x_fill_rectangle (s->f, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
3667 s->width, h);
3668 else
3669 {
3670 XGCValues xgcv;
3671 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
3672 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
3673 x_fill_rectangle (s->f, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
3674 s->width, h);
3675 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
3676 }
3677 }
3678
3679 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
3680 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
3681 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
3682
3683 if (s->prev)
3684 {
3685 struct glyph_string *prev;
3686
3687 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
3688 if (prev->hl != s->hl
3689 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
3690 {
3691 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
3692 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
3693 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
3694
3695 prev->hl = s->hl;
3696 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
3697 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
3698 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
3699 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
3700 else
3701 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
3702 x_reset_clip_rectangles (prev->f, prev->gc);
3703 prev->hl = save;
3704 prev->num_clips = 0;
3705 }
3706 }
3707
3708 if (s->next)
3709 {
3710 struct glyph_string *next;
3711
3712 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
3713 if (next->hl != s->hl
3714 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
3715 {
3716 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
3717 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
3718 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
3719
3720 next->hl = s->hl;
3721 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
3722 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
3723 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
3724 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
3725 else
3726 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
3727 x_reset_clip_rectangles (next->f, next->gc);
3728 next->hl = save;
3729 next->num_clips = 0;
3730 next->clip_head = s->next;
3731 }
3732 }
3733 }
3734
3735 /* Reset clipping. */
3736 x_reset_clip_rectangles (s->f, s->gc);
3737 s->num_clips = 0;
3738 }
3739
3740 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
3741
3742 static void
3743 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
3744 {
3745 /* Never called on a GUI frame, see
3746 http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/emacs-devel/2015-05/msg00456.html
3747 */
3748 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3749 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3750 x, y, width, height,
3751 x + shift_by, y);
3752 }
3753
3754 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
3755 for X frames. */
3756
3757 static void
3758 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
3759 {
3760 emacs_abort ();
3761 }
3762
3763
3764 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
3765 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
3766
3767 static void
3768 x_clear_area1 (Display *dpy, Window window,
3769 int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
3770 {
3771 eassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
3772 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
3773 }
3774
3775
3776 void
3777 x_clear_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
3778 {
3779 #ifdef USE_CAIRO
3780 cairo_t *cr;
3781
3782 eassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
3783
3784 cr = x_begin_cr_clip (f, NULL);
3785 x_set_cr_source_with_gc_background (f, f->output_data.x->normal_gc);
3786 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, width, height);
3787 cairo_fill (cr);
3788 x_end_cr_clip (f);
3789 #else
3790 x_clear_area1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3791 x, y, width, height, False);
3792 #endif
3793 }
3794
3795
3796 /* Clear an entire frame. */
3797
3798 static void
3799 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
3800 {
3801 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
3802 longer visible. */
3803 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
3804
3805 block_input ();
3806
3807 x_clear_window (f);
3808
3809 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
3810 something like that, then they should be notified. */
3811 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
3812
3813 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3814 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
3815 redisplay, do it here. */
3816 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
3817 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3818 #endif
3819
3820 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3821
3822 unblock_input ();
3823 }
3824
3825 /* RIF: Show hourglass cursor on frame F. */
3826
3827 static void
3828 x_show_hourglass (struct frame *f)
3829 {
3830 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
3831
3832 if (dpy)
3833 {
3834 struct x_output *x = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f);
3835 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3836 if (x->widget)
3837 #else
3838 if (FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f))
3839 #endif
3840 {
3841 x->hourglass_p = true;
3842
3843 if (!x->hourglass_window)
3844 {
3845 unsigned long mask = CWCursor;
3846 XSetWindowAttributes attrs;
3847 #ifdef USE_GTK
3848 Window parent = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
3849 #else
3850 Window parent = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
3851 #endif
3852 attrs.cursor = x->hourglass_cursor;
3853
3854 x->hourglass_window = XCreateWindow
3855 (dpy, parent, 0, 0, 32000, 32000, 0, 0,
3856 InputOnly, CopyFromParent, mask, &attrs);
3857 }
3858
3859 XMapRaised (dpy, x->hourglass_window);
3860 XFlush (dpy);
3861 }
3862 }
3863 }
3864
3865 /* RIF: Cancel hourglass cursor on frame F. */
3866
3867 static void
3868 x_hide_hourglass (struct frame *f)
3869 {
3870 struct x_output *x = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f);
3871
3872 /* Watch out for newly created frames. */
3873 if (x->hourglass_window)
3874 {
3875 XUnmapWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), x->hourglass_window);
3876 /* Sync here because XTread_socket looks at the
3877 hourglass_p flag that is reset to zero below. */
3878 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
3879 x->hourglass_p = false;
3880 }
3881 }
3882
3883 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
3884
3885 static void
3886 XTflash (struct frame *f)
3887 {
3888 block_input ();
3889
3890 {
3891 #ifdef USE_GTK
3892 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3893 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3894 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3895 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3896 cairo_t *cr = gdk_cairo_create (window);
3897 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr, 1, 1, 1);
3898 cairo_set_operator (cr, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE);
3899 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3900 do { \
3901 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3902 cairo_fill (cr); \
3903 } \
3904 while (false)
3905 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3906 GdkGCValues vals;
3907 GdkGC *gc;
3908 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3909 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3910 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3911 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3912 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3913 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3914 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, true, x, y, w, h)
3915 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3916 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3917 GC gc;
3918
3919 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3920 pixels into background pixels. */
3921 {
3922 XGCValues values;
3923
3924 values.function = GXxor;
3925 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3926 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3927
3928 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3929 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3930 }
3931 #endif
3932 {
3933 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3934 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
3935 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3936 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3937 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3938 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3939 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3940 int width = flash_right - flash_left;
3941
3942 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3943 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3944 {
3945 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3946 flash_left,
3947 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3948 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3949 width, flash_height);
3950 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3951 flash_left,
3952 (height - flash_height
3953 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3954 width, flash_height);
3955
3956 }
3957 else
3958 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3959 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3960 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3961 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3962
3963 x_flush (f);
3964
3965 {
3966 struct timespec delay = make_timespec (0, 150 * 1000 * 1000);
3967 struct timespec wakeup = timespec_add (current_timespec (), delay);
3968
3969 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3970 available. */
3971 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3972 {
3973 struct timespec current = current_timespec ();
3974 struct timespec timeout;
3975
3976 /* Break if result would not be positive. */
3977 if (timespec_cmp (wakeup, current) <= 0)
3978 break;
3979
3980 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3981 timeout = make_timespec (0, 10 * 1000 * 1000);
3982
3983 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3984 pselect (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout, NULL);
3985 }
3986 }
3987
3988 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3989 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3990 {
3991 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3992 flash_left,
3993 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3994 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3995 width, flash_height);
3996 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3997 flash_left,
3998 (height - flash_height
3999 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
4000 width, flash_height);
4001 }
4002 else
4003 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
4004 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
4005 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
4006 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
4007
4008 #ifdef USE_GTK
4009 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
4010 cairo_destroy (cr);
4011 #else
4012 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
4013 #endif
4014 #undef XFillRectangle
4015 #else
4016 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
4017 #endif
4018 x_flush (f);
4019 }
4020 }
4021
4022 unblock_input ();
4023 }
4024
4025
4026 static void
4027 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (struct frame *f, bool invisible)
4028 {
4029 block_input ();
4030 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->toggle_visible_pointer (f, invisible);
4031 unblock_input ();
4032 }
4033
4034
4035 /* Make audible bell. */
4036
4037 static void
4038 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
4039 {
4040 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
4041 {
4042 if (visible_bell)
4043 XTflash (f);
4044 else
4045 {
4046 block_input ();
4047 #ifdef HAVE_XKB
4048 XkbBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, 0, None);
4049 #else
4050 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
4051 #endif
4052 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4053 unblock_input ();
4054 }
4055 }
4056 }
4057
4058 /***********************************************************************
4059 Line Dance
4060 ***********************************************************************/
4061
4062 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
4063 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
4064
4065 static void
4066 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
4067 {
4068 emacs_abort ();
4069 }
4070
4071
4072 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
4073
4074 static void
4075 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
4076 {
4077 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4078 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
4079
4080 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
4081 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
4082 fringe of W. */
4083 window_box (w, ANY_AREA, &x, &y, &width, &height);
4084
4085 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
4086 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
4087 bottom_y = y + height;
4088
4089 if (to_y < from_y)
4090 {
4091 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
4092 line at the bottom. */
4093 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
4094 height = bottom_y - from_y;
4095 else
4096 height = run->height;
4097 }
4098 else
4099 {
4100 /* Scrolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
4101 at the bottom. */
4102 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
4103 height = bottom_y - to_y;
4104 else
4105 height = run->height;
4106 }
4107
4108 block_input ();
4109
4110 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
4111 x_clear_cursor (w);
4112
4113 #ifdef USE_CAIRO
4114 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
4115 #else
4116 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4117 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4118 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
4119 x, from_y,
4120 width, height,
4121 x, to_y);
4122 #endif
4123
4124 unblock_input ();
4125 }
4126
4127
4128 \f
4129 /***********************************************************************
4130 Exposure Events
4131 ***********************************************************************/
4132
4133 \f
4134 static void
4135 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
4136 {
4137 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
4138 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
4139 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
4140 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
4141 block_input ();
4142 /* I recently started to get errors in this XSetWindowBorder, depending on
4143 the window-manager in use, tho something more is at play since I've been
4144 using that same window-manager binary for ever. Let's not crash just
4145 because of this (bug#9310). */
4146 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4147 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4148 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
4149 x_uncatch_errors ();
4150 unblock_input ();
4151 x_update_cursor (f, true);
4152 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
4153 }
4154
4155 static void
4156 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
4157 {
4158 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
4159 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
4160 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
4161 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
4162 block_input ();
4163 /* Same as above for XSetWindowBorder (bug#9310). */
4164 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4165 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4166 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
4167 x_uncatch_errors ();
4168 unblock_input ();
4169 x_update_cursor (f, true);
4170 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
4171 }
4172
4173 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
4174 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
4175 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
4176 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
4177 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
4178
4179 static void
4180 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
4181 {
4182 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
4183
4184 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
4185 {
4186 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
4187 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
4188 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
4189
4190 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
4191 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
4192
4193 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
4194 dpyinfo->x_pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
4195 else
4196 dpyinfo->x_pending_autoraise_frame = NULL;
4197 }
4198
4199 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
4200 }
4201
4202 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
4203 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
4204 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
4205
4206 static void
4207 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
4208 {
4209 if (type == FocusIn)
4210 {
4211 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
4212 {
4213 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
4214 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
4215
4216 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
4217 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
4218 /* When run as a daemon, Vterminal_frame is always NIL. */
4219 bufp->arg = (((NILP (Vterminal_frame)
4220 || ! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (Vterminal_frame))
4221 || EQ (Fdaemonp (), Qt))
4222 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
4223 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
4224 ? Qt : Qnil);
4225 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
4226 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
4227 }
4228
4229 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
4230
4231 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
4232 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
4233 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
4234 #endif
4235 }
4236 else if (type == FocusOut)
4237 {
4238 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
4239
4240 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
4241 {
4242 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
4243 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
4244
4245 bufp->kind = FOCUS_OUT_EVENT;
4246 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
4247 }
4248
4249 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
4250 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
4251 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
4252 #endif
4253 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
4254 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, false);
4255 }
4256 }
4257
4258 /* Return the Emacs frame-object corresponding to an X window.
4259 It could be the frame's main window or an icon window. */
4260
4261 static struct frame *
4262 x_window_to_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int wdesc)
4263 {
4264 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
4265 struct frame *f;
4266
4267 if (wdesc == None)
4268 return NULL;
4269
4270 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4271 {
4272 f = XFRAME (frame);
4273 if (!FRAME_X_P (f) || FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f) != dpyinfo)
4274 continue;
4275 if (f->output_data.x->hourglass_window == wdesc)
4276 return f;
4277 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4278 if ((f->output_data.x->edit_widget
4279 && XtWindow (f->output_data.x->edit_widget) == wdesc)
4280 /* A tooltip frame? */
4281 || (!f->output_data.x->edit_widget
4282 && FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == wdesc)
4283 || f->output_data.x->icon_desc == wdesc)
4284 return f;
4285 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4286 #ifdef USE_GTK
4287 if (f->output_data.x->edit_widget)
4288 {
4289 GtkWidget *gwdesc = xg_win_to_widget (dpyinfo->display, wdesc);
4290 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x;
4291 if (gwdesc != 0 && gwdesc == x->edit_widget)
4292 return f;
4293 }
4294 #endif /* USE_GTK */
4295 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == wdesc
4296 || f->output_data.x->icon_desc == wdesc)
4297 return f;
4298 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4299 }
4300 return 0;
4301 }
4302
4303 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
4304
4305 /* Like x_window_to_frame but also compares the window with the widget's
4306 windows. */
4307
4308 static struct frame *
4309 x_any_window_to_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int wdesc)
4310 {
4311 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
4312 struct frame *f, *found = NULL;
4313 struct x_output *x;
4314
4315 if (wdesc == None)
4316 return NULL;
4317
4318 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4319 {
4320 if (found)
4321 break;
4322 f = XFRAME (frame);
4323 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
4324 {
4325 /* This frame matches if the window is any of its widgets. */
4326 x = f->output_data.x;
4327 if (x->hourglass_window == wdesc)
4328 found = f;
4329 else if (x->widget)
4330 {
4331 #ifdef USE_GTK
4332 GtkWidget *gwdesc = xg_win_to_widget (dpyinfo->display, wdesc);
4333 if (gwdesc != 0
4334 && gtk_widget_get_toplevel (gwdesc) == x->widget)
4335 found = f;
4336 #else
4337 if (wdesc == XtWindow (x->widget)
4338 || wdesc == XtWindow (x->column_widget)
4339 || wdesc == XtWindow (x->edit_widget))
4340 found = f;
4341 /* Match if the window is this frame's menubar. */
4342 else if (lw_window_is_in_menubar (wdesc, x->menubar_widget))
4343 found = f;
4344 #endif
4345 }
4346 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == wdesc)
4347 /* A tooltip frame. */
4348 found = f;
4349 }
4350 }
4351
4352 return found;
4353 }
4354
4355 /* Likewise, but consider only the menu bar widget. */
4356
4357 static struct frame *
4358 x_menubar_window_to_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo,
4359 const XEvent *event)
4360 {
4361 Window wdesc = event->xany.window;
4362 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
4363 struct frame *f;
4364 struct x_output *x;
4365
4366 if (wdesc == None)
4367 return NULL;
4368
4369 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4370 {
4371 f = XFRAME (frame);
4372 if (!FRAME_X_P (f) || FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f) != dpyinfo)
4373 continue;
4374 x = f->output_data.x;
4375 #ifdef USE_GTK
4376 if (x->menubar_widget && xg_event_is_for_menubar (f, event))
4377 return f;
4378 #else
4379 /* Match if the window is this frame's menubar. */
4380 if (x->menubar_widget
4381 && lw_window_is_in_menubar (wdesc, x->menubar_widget))
4382 return f;
4383 #endif
4384 }
4385 return 0;
4386 }
4387
4388 /* Return the frame whose principal (outermost) window is WDESC.
4389 If WDESC is some other (smaller) window, we return 0. */
4390
4391 struct frame *
4392 x_top_window_to_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int wdesc)
4393 {
4394 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
4395 struct frame *f;
4396 struct x_output *x;
4397
4398 if (wdesc == None)
4399 return NULL;
4400
4401 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4402 {
4403 f = XFRAME (frame);
4404 if (!FRAME_X_P (f) || FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f) != dpyinfo)
4405 continue;
4406 x = f->output_data.x;
4407
4408 if (x->widget)
4409 {
4410 /* This frame matches if the window is its topmost widget. */
4411 #ifdef USE_GTK
4412 GtkWidget *gwdesc = xg_win_to_widget (dpyinfo->display, wdesc);
4413 if (gwdesc == x->widget)
4414 return f;
4415 #else
4416 if (wdesc == XtWindow (x->widget))
4417 return f;
4418 #endif
4419 }
4420 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == wdesc)
4421 /* Tooltip frame. */
4422 return f;
4423 }
4424 return 0;
4425 }
4426
4427 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT && !USE_GTK */
4428
4429 #define x_any_window_to_frame(d, i) x_window_to_frame (d, i)
4430 #define x_top_window_to_frame(d, i) x_window_to_frame (d, i)
4431
4432 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
4433
4434 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
4435 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
4436
4437 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
4438
4439 static void
4440 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame,
4441 const XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
4442 {
4443 if (!frame)
4444 return;
4445
4446 switch (event->type)
4447 {
4448 case EnterNotify:
4449 case LeaveNotify:
4450 {
4451 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
4452 int focus_state
4453 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
4454
4455 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
4456 && event->xcrossing.focus
4457 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
4458 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
4459 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
4460 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
4461 }
4462 break;
4463
4464 case FocusIn:
4465 case FocusOut:
4466 x_focus_changed (event->type,
4467 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
4468 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
4469 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
4470 break;
4471
4472 case ClientMessage:
4473 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
4474 {
4475 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
4476 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
4477 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
4478 }
4479 break;
4480 }
4481 }
4482
4483
4484 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
4485 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
4486
4487 void
4488 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
4489 {
4490 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
4491 }
4492 #endif
4493
4494 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
4495 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
4496 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
4497
4498 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
4499 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
4500 the appropriate X display info. */
4501
4502 static void
4503 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
4504 {
4505 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
4506 }
4507
4508 static void
4509 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
4510 {
4511 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
4512
4513 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
4514 {
4515 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
4516 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
4517 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
4518 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
4519 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
4520 {
4521 fset_focus_frame (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame, Qnil);
4522 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
4523 }
4524 }
4525 else
4526 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
4527
4528 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
4529 {
4530 if (old_highlight)
4531 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
4532 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
4533 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
4534 }
4535 }
4536
4537
4538 \f
4539 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
4540
4541 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
4542 static void
4543 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
4544 {
4545 int min_code, max_code;
4546 KeySym *syms;
4547 int syms_per_code;
4548 XModifierKeymap *mods;
4549
4550 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
4551 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
4552 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
4553 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
4554 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
4555
4556 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
4557
4558 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
4559 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
4560 &syms_per_code);
4561 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
4562
4563 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
4564 Alt keysyms are on. */
4565 {
4566 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
4567 bool found_alt_or_meta;
4568
4569 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
4570 {
4571 found_alt_or_meta = false;
4572 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
4573 {
4574 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
4575
4576 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
4577 if (code == 0)
4578 continue;
4579
4580 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
4581 {
4582 int code_col;
4583
4584 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
4585 {
4586 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
4587
4588 switch (sym)
4589 {
4590 case XK_Meta_L:
4591 case XK_Meta_R:
4592 found_alt_or_meta = true;
4593 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
4594 break;
4595
4596 case XK_Alt_L:
4597 case XK_Alt_R:
4598 found_alt_or_meta = true;
4599 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
4600 break;
4601
4602 case XK_Hyper_L:
4603 case XK_Hyper_R:
4604 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
4605 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
4606 code_col = syms_per_code;
4607 col = mods->max_keypermod;
4608 break;
4609
4610 case XK_Super_L:
4611 case XK_Super_R:
4612 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
4613 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
4614 code_col = syms_per_code;
4615 col = mods->max_keypermod;
4616 break;
4617
4618 case XK_Shift_Lock:
4619 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
4620 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
4621 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
4622 code_col = syms_per_code;
4623 col = mods->max_keypermod;
4624 break;
4625 }
4626 }
4627 }
4628 }
4629 }
4630 }
4631
4632 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
4633 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
4634 {
4635 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
4636 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
4637 }
4638
4639 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
4640 make them just meta, not alt. */
4641 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
4642 {
4643 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
4644 }
4645
4646 XFree (syms);
4647 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
4648 }
4649
4650 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
4651 Emacs uses. */
4652
4653 int
4654 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int state)
4655 {
4656 int mod_meta = meta_modifier;
4657 int mod_alt = alt_modifier;
4658 int mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
4659 int mod_super = super_modifier;
4660 Lisp_Object tem;
4661
4662 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
4663 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
4664 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
4665 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
4666 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
4667 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
4668 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
4669 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
4670
4671 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
4672 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
4673 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
4674 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
4675 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
4676 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
4677 }
4678
4679 static int
4680 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, EMACS_INT state)
4681 {
4682 EMACS_INT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
4683 EMACS_INT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
4684 EMACS_INT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
4685 EMACS_INT mod_super = super_modifier;
4686
4687 Lisp_Object tem;
4688
4689 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
4690 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem);
4691 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
4692 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem);
4693 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
4694 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem);
4695 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
4696 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem);
4697
4698
4699 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
4700 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
4701 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
4702 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
4703 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
4704 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
4705 }
4706
4707 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
4708
4709 char *
4710 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
4711 {
4712 char *value;
4713
4714 block_input ();
4715 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
4716 unblock_input ();
4717
4718 return value;
4719 }
4720
4721 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah.
4722
4723 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
4724 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
4725 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
4726 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
4727
4728 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
4729
4730 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
4731 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
4732 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
4733 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
4734 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
4735 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
4736 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
4737 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
4738 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
4739 is off. */
4740
4741 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
4742
4743 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
4744 the mouse. */
4745
4746 static Lisp_Object
4747 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result,
4748 const XButtonEvent *event,
4749 struct frame *f)
4750 {
4751 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
4752 otherwise. */
4753 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
4754 result->code = event->button - Button1;
4755 result->timestamp = event->time;
4756 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
4757 event->state)
4758 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
4759 ? up_modifier
4760 : down_modifier));
4761
4762 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
4763 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
4764 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
4765 result->arg = Qnil;
4766 return Qnil;
4767 }
4768
4769 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
4770 The input handler calls this.
4771
4772 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
4773 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
4774 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
4775 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
4776
4777 static bool
4778 note_mouse_movement (struct frame *frame, const XMotionEvent *event)
4779 {
4780 XRectangle *r;
4781 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
4782
4783 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
4784 return false;
4785
4786 dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (frame);
4787 dpyinfo->last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
4788 dpyinfo->last_mouse_motion_frame = frame;
4789 dpyinfo->last_mouse_motion_x = event->x;
4790 dpyinfo->last_mouse_motion_y = event->y;
4791
4792 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
4793 {
4794 frame->mouse_moved = true;
4795 dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar = NULL;
4796 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
4797 dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph_frame = NULL;
4798 return true;
4799 }
4800
4801
4802 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
4803 r = &dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph;
4804 if (frame != dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph_frame
4805 || event->x < r->x || event->x >= r->x + r->width
4806 || event->y < r->y || event->y >= r->y + r->height)
4807 {
4808 frame->mouse_moved = true;
4809 dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar = NULL;
4810 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
4811 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
4812 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, r);
4813 dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
4814 return true;
4815 }
4816
4817 return false;
4818 }
4819
4820 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
4821 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
4822
4823 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
4824 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
4825 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
4826 position on the scroll bar.
4827
4828 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
4829 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
4830 the mouse is over.
4831
4832 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
4833 was at this position.
4834
4835 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
4836
4837 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
4838 movement. */
4839
4840 static void
4841 XTmouse_position (struct frame **fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
4842 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y,
4843 Time *timestamp)
4844 {
4845 struct frame *f1;
4846 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp);
4847
4848 block_input ();
4849
4850 if (dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar && insist == 0)
4851 {
4852 struct scroll_bar *bar = dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar;
4853
4854 if (bar->horizontal)
4855 x_horizontal_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
4856 else
4857 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
4858 }
4859 else
4860 {
4861 Window root;
4862 int root_x, root_y;
4863
4864 Window dummy_window;
4865 int dummy;
4866
4867 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
4868
4869 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
4870 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4871 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
4872 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
4873 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = false;
4874
4875 dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar = NULL;
4876
4877 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
4878 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
4879 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
4880
4881 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
4882 &root,
4883
4884 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
4885 a different screen. */
4886 &dummy_window,
4887
4888 /* The position on that root window. */
4889 &root_x, &root_y,
4890
4891 /* More trash we can't trust. */
4892 &dummy, &dummy,
4893
4894 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
4895 we don't care. */
4896 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
4897
4898 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
4899 containing the pointer. */
4900 {
4901 Window win, child;
4902 int win_x, win_y;
4903 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
4904
4905 win = root;
4906
4907 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
4908 structure is changing at the same time this function
4909 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
4910
4911 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
4912
4913 if (x_mouse_grabbed (dpyinfo))
4914 {
4915 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
4916 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
4917 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
4918
4919 /* From-window. */
4920 root,
4921
4922 /* To-window. */
4923 FRAME_X_WINDOW (dpyinfo->last_mouse_frame),
4924
4925 /* From-position, to-position. */
4926 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
4927
4928 /* Child of win. */
4929 &child);
4930 f1 = dpyinfo->last_mouse_frame;
4931 }
4932 else
4933 {
4934 while (true)
4935 {
4936 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
4937
4938 /* From-window, to-window. */
4939 root, win,
4940
4941 /* From-position, to-position. */
4942 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
4943
4944 /* Child of win. */
4945 &child);
4946
4947 if (child == None || child == win)
4948 break;
4949 #ifdef USE_GTK
4950 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4951 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
4952 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
4953 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
4954 if (x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, win))
4955 break;
4956 #endif
4957 win = child;
4958 parent_x = win_x;
4959 parent_y = win_y;
4960 }
4961
4962 /* Now we know that:
4963 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
4964 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
4965 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
4966 (XTC did this the last time through), and
4967 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
4968 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
4969 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
4970 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
4971 never use them in that case.) */
4972
4973 #ifdef USE_GTK
4974 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4975 want the edit window. */
4976 f1 = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, win);
4977 #else
4978 /* Is win one of our frames? */
4979 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, win);
4980 #endif
4981
4982 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4983 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
4984 on the frame. */
4985 if (f1 != NULL
4986 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
4987 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
4988 f1 = NULL;
4989 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4990 }
4991
4992 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
4993 f1 = 0;
4994
4995 x_uncatch_errors ();
4996
4997 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
4998 if (! f1)
4999 {
5000 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5001
5002 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win, 2);
5003
5004 if (bar)
5005 {
5006 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5007 win_x = parent_x;
5008 win_y = parent_y;
5009 }
5010 }
5011
5012 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
5013 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
5014
5015 if (f1)
5016 {
5017 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
5018 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
5019 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
5020 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
5021 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
5022 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
5023 the frame are divided into. */
5024
5025 /* FIXME: what if F1 is not an X frame? */
5026 dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f1);
5027 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph);
5028 dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
5029
5030 *bar_window = Qnil;
5031 *part = 0;
5032 *fp = f1;
5033 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
5034 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
5035 *timestamp = dpyinfo->last_mouse_movement_time;
5036 }
5037 }
5038 }
5039
5040 unblock_input ();
5041 }
5042
5043
5044 \f
5045 /***********************************************************************
5046 Scroll bars
5047 ***********************************************************************/
5048
5049 /* Scroll bar support. */
5050
5051 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
5052 manages it.
5053 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
5054 bits. */
5055
5056 static struct scroll_bar *
5057 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id, int type)
5058 {
5059 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
5060
5061 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
5062 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
5063 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5064
5065 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
5066 {
5067 Lisp_Object bar, condemned;
5068
5069 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
5070 continue;
5071
5072 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
5073 right window ID. */
5074 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
5075 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
5076 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
5077 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
5078 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
5079 condemned = Qnil,
5080 ! NILP (bar));
5081 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5082 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id
5083 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display
5084 && (type = 2
5085 || (type == 1 && XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->horizontal)
5086 || (type == 0 && !XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->horizontal)))
5087 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5088 }
5089
5090 return NULL;
5091 }
5092
5093
5094 #if defined USE_LUCID
5095
5096 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
5097 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
5098
5099 static Widget
5100 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
5101 {
5102 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
5103
5104 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
5105 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
5106 {
5107 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
5108
5109 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
5110 return menu_bar;
5111 }
5112 return NULL;
5113 }
5114
5115 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
5116
5117 \f
5118 /************************************************************************
5119 Toolkit scroll bars
5120 ************************************************************************/
5121
5122 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5123
5124 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, enum scroll_bar_part,
5125 int, int, bool);
5126
5127 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
5128 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
5129
5130 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
5131
5132 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
5133 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
5134
5135 #ifndef USE_GTK
5136 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
5137
5138 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
5139 static XtActionHookId horizontal_action_hook_id;
5140
5141 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
5142
5143 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
5144 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
5145 to avoid jerkiness. */
5146
5147 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
5148
5149 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
5150 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
5151 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
5152 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
5153
5154 static void
5155 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
5156 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
5157 {
5158 bool scroll_bar_p;
5159 const char *end_action;
5160
5161 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
5162 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
5163 end_action = "Release";
5164 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
5165 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
5166 end_action = "EndScroll";
5167 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
5168
5169 if (scroll_bar_p
5170 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
5171 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
5172 {
5173 struct window *w;
5174 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5175
5176 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
5177 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0, false);
5178 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
5179 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5180
5181 if (bar->dragging != -1)
5182 {
5183 bar->dragging = -1;
5184 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
5185 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
5186 }
5187 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
5188 #if defined (USE_LUCID)
5189 bar->last_seen_part = scroll_bar_nowhere;
5190 #endif
5191 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
5192 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = false;
5193 }
5194 }
5195
5196
5197 static void
5198 xt_horizontal_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
5199 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
5200 {
5201 bool scroll_bar_p;
5202 const char *end_action;
5203
5204 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
5205 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
5206 end_action = "Release";
5207 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
5208 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
5209 end_action = "EndScroll";
5210 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
5211
5212 if (scroll_bar_p
5213 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
5214 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
5215 {
5216 struct window *w;
5217 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5218
5219 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
5220 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0, true);
5221 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
5222 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->horizontal_scroll_bar);
5223
5224 if (bar->dragging != -1)
5225 {
5226 bar->dragging = -1;
5227 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
5228 set_horizontal_scroll_bar (w);
5229 }
5230 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
5231 #if defined (USE_LUCID)
5232 bar->last_seen_part = scroll_bar_nowhere;
5233 #endif
5234 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
5235 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = false;
5236 }
5237 }
5238 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5239
5240 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
5241 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
5242 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
5243 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
5244
5245 static void
5246 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, enum scroll_bar_part part,
5247 int portion, int whole, bool horizontal)
5248 {
5249 XEvent event;
5250 XClientMessageEvent *ev = &event.xclient;
5251 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
5252 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5253 intptr_t iw = (intptr_t) w;
5254 enum { BITS_PER_INTPTR = CHAR_BIT * sizeof iw };
5255 verify (BITS_PER_INTPTR <= 64);
5256 int sign_shift = BITS_PER_INTPTR - 32;
5257
5258 block_input ();
5259
5260 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
5261 ev->type = ClientMessage;
5262 ev->message_type = (horizontal
5263 ? FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Horizontal_Scrollbar
5264 : FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar);
5265 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
5266 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
5267 ev->format = 32;
5268
5269 /* A 32-bit X client on a 64-bit X server can pass a window pointer
5270 as-is. A 64-bit client on a 32-bit X server is in trouble
5271 because a pointer does not fit and would be truncated while
5272 passing through the server. So use two slots and hope that X12
5273 will resolve such issues someday. */
5274 ev->data.l[0] = iw >> 31 >> 1;
5275 ev->data.l[1] = sign_shift <= 0 ? iw : iw << sign_shift >> sign_shift;
5276 ev->data.l[2] = part;
5277 ev->data.l[3] = portion;
5278 ev->data.l[4] = whole;
5279
5280 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
5281 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5282 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = true;
5283 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
5284 #endif
5285
5286 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
5287 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
5288 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
5289 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
5290 unblock_input ();
5291 }
5292
5293
5294 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
5295 in *IEVENT. */
5296
5297 static void
5298 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (const XEvent *event,
5299 struct input_event *ievent)
5300 {
5301 const XClientMessageEvent *ev = &event->xclient;
5302 Lisp_Object window;
5303 struct window *w;
5304
5305 /* See the comment in the function above. */
5306 intptr_t iw0 = ev->data.l[0];
5307 intptr_t iw1 = ev->data.l[1];
5308 intptr_t iw = (iw0 << 31 << 1) + (iw1 & 0xffffffffu);
5309 w = (struct window *) iw;
5310
5311 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
5312
5313 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5314 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
5315 ievent->arg = Qnil;
5316 #ifdef USE_GTK
5317 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
5318 #else
5319 ievent->timestamp =
5320 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w->frame)));
5321 #endif
5322 ievent->code = 0;
5323 ievent->part = ev->data.l[2];
5324 ievent->x = make_number (ev->data.l[3]);
5325 ievent->y = make_number (ev->data.l[4]);
5326 ievent->modifiers = 0;
5327 }
5328
5329 /* Transform a horizontal scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs
5330 input event in *IEVENT. */
5331
5332 static void
5333 x_horizontal_scroll_bar_to_input_event (const XEvent *event,
5334 struct input_event *ievent)
5335 {
5336 const XClientMessageEvent *ev = &event->xclient;
5337 Lisp_Object window;
5338 struct window *w;
5339
5340 /* See the comment in the function above. */
5341 intptr_t iw0 = ev->data.l[0];
5342 intptr_t iw1 = ev->data.l[1];
5343 intptr_t iw = (iw0 << 31 << 1) + (iw1 & 0xffffffffu);
5344 w = (struct window *) iw;
5345
5346 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
5347
5348 ievent->kind = HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5349 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
5350 ievent->arg = Qnil;
5351 #ifdef USE_GTK
5352 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
5353 #else
5354 ievent->timestamp =
5355 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w->frame)));
5356 #endif
5357 ievent->code = 0;
5358 ievent->part = ev->data.l[2];
5359 ievent->x = make_number (ev->data.l[3]);
5360 ievent->y = make_number (ev->data.l[4]);
5361 ievent->modifiers = 0;
5362 }
5363
5364
5365 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
5366
5367 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
5368
5369 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
5370
5371 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
5372 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
5373 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
5374
5375 static void
5376 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
5377 {
5378 struct scroll_bar *bar = client_data;
5379 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = call_data;
5380 enum scroll_bar_part part = scroll_bar_nowhere;
5381 bool horizontal = bar->horizontal;
5382 int whole = 0, portion = 0;
5383
5384 switch (cs->reason)
5385 {
5386 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
5387 bar->dragging = -1;
5388 part = horizontal ? scroll_bar_left_arrow : scroll_bar_up_arrow;
5389 break;
5390
5391 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
5392 bar->dragging = -1;
5393 part = horizontal ? scroll_bar_right_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
5394 break;
5395
5396 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
5397 bar->dragging = -1;
5398 part = horizontal ? scroll_bar_before_handle : scroll_bar_above_handle;
5399 break;
5400
5401 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
5402 bar->dragging = -1;
5403 part = horizontal ? scroll_bar_after_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
5404 break;
5405
5406 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
5407 bar->dragging = -1;
5408 part = horizontal ? scroll_bar_to_leftmost : scroll_bar_to_top;
5409 break;
5410
5411 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
5412 bar->dragging = -1;
5413 part = horizontal ? scroll_bar_to_rightmost : scroll_bar_to_bottom;
5414 break;
5415
5416 case XmCR_DRAG:
5417 {
5418 int slider_size;
5419
5420 block_input ();
5421 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
5422 unblock_input ();
5423
5424 if (horizontal)
5425 {
5426 portion = bar->whole * ((float)cs->value / XM_SB_MAX);
5427 whole = bar->whole * ((float)(XM_SB_MAX - slider_size) / XM_SB_MAX);
5428 portion = min (portion, whole);
5429 part = scroll_bar_horizontal_handle;
5430 }
5431 else
5432 {
5433 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
5434 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
5435 part = scroll_bar_handle;
5436 }
5437
5438 bar->dragging = cs->value;
5439 }
5440 break;
5441
5442 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
5443 break;
5444 };
5445
5446 if (part != scroll_bar_nowhere)
5447 {
5448 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
5449 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole,
5450 bar->horizontal);
5451 }
5452 }
5453
5454 #elif defined USE_GTK
5455
5456 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
5457 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
5458
5459 static gboolean
5460 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
5461 GtkScrollType scroll,
5462 gdouble value,
5463 gpointer user_data)
5464 {
5465 int whole = 0, portion = 0;
5466 struct scroll_bar *bar = user_data;
5467 enum scroll_bar_part part = scroll_bar_nowhere;
5468 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
5469 struct frame *f = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
5470
5471 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return false;
5472
5473 switch (scroll)
5474 {
5475 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
5476 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
5477 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
5478 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
5479 {
5480 if (bar->horizontal)
5481 {
5482 part = scroll_bar_horizontal_handle;
5483 whole = (int)(gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
5484 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj));
5485 portion = min ((int)value, whole);
5486 bar->dragging = portion;
5487 }
5488 else
5489 {
5490 part = scroll_bar_handle;
5491 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
5492 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
5493 portion = min ((int)value, whole);
5494 bar->dragging = portion;
5495 }
5496 }
5497 break;
5498 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
5499 part = (bar->horizontal
5500 ? scroll_bar_left_arrow : scroll_bar_up_arrow);
5501 bar->dragging = -1;
5502 break;
5503 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
5504 part = (bar->horizontal
5505 ? scroll_bar_right_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow);
5506 bar->dragging = -1;
5507 break;
5508 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
5509 part = (bar->horizontal
5510 ? scroll_bar_before_handle : scroll_bar_above_handle);
5511 bar->dragging = -1;
5512 break;
5513 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
5514 part = (bar->horizontal
5515 ? scroll_bar_after_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle);
5516 bar->dragging = -1;
5517 break;
5518 default:
5519 break;
5520 }
5521
5522 if (part != scroll_bar_nowhere)
5523 {
5524 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
5525 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole,
5526 bar->horizontal);
5527 }
5528
5529 return false;
5530 }
5531
5532 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to -1 when dragging is done. */
5533
5534 static gboolean
5535 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
5536 GdkEventButton *event,
5537 gpointer user_data)
5538 {
5539 struct scroll_bar *bar = user_data;
5540 bar->dragging = -1;
5541 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
5542 {
5543 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
5544 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0, bar->horizontal);
5545 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
5546 }
5547
5548 return false;
5549 }
5550
5551
5552 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
5553
5554 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
5555 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
5556 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
5557 the thumb is. */
5558
5559 static void
5560 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
5561 {
5562 struct scroll_bar *bar = client_data;
5563 float *top_addr = call_data;
5564 float top = *top_addr;
5565 float shown;
5566 int whole, portion, height, width;
5567 enum scroll_bar_part part;
5568 bool horizontal = bar->horizontal;
5569
5570
5571 if (horizontal)
5572 {
5573 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
5574 block_input ();
5575 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNwidth, &width, NULL);
5576 unblock_input ();
5577
5578 if (shown < 1)
5579 {
5580 whole = bar->whole - (shown * bar->whole);
5581 portion = min (top * bar->whole, whole);
5582 }
5583 else
5584 {
5585 whole = bar->whole;
5586 portion = 0;
5587 }
5588
5589 part = scroll_bar_horizontal_handle;
5590 }
5591 else
5592 {
5593 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
5594 block_input ();
5595 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
5596 unblock_input ();
5597
5598 whole = 10000000;
5599 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
5600
5601 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0f / height))
5602 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
5603 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
5604 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
5605 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
5606 bottom). */
5607 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
5608 else
5609 part = scroll_bar_handle;
5610 }
5611
5612 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
5613 bar->dragging = portion;
5614 bar->last_seen_part = part;
5615 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole, bar->horizontal);
5616 }
5617
5618
5619 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
5620 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
5621 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
5622 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
5623 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
5624 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
5625 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
5626
5627 static void
5628 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
5629 {
5630 struct scroll_bar *bar = client_data;
5631 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
5632 int position = (intptr_t) call_data;
5633 Dimension height, width;
5634 enum scroll_bar_part part;
5635
5636 if (bar->horizontal)
5637 {
5638 /* Get the width of the scroll bar. */
5639 block_input ();
5640 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNwidth, &width, NULL);
5641 unblock_input ();
5642
5643 if (eabs (position) >= width)
5644 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_before_handle : scroll_bar_after_handle;
5645
5646 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
5647 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
5648 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, width / 20))
5649 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_left_arrow : scroll_bar_right_arrow;
5650 else
5651 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
5652
5653 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
5654 bar->dragging = -1;
5655 bar->last_seen_part = part;
5656 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, width,
5657 bar->horizontal);
5658 }
5659 else
5660 {
5661
5662 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
5663 block_input ();
5664 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
5665 unblock_input ();
5666
5667 if (eabs (position) >= height)
5668 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
5669
5670 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
5671 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
5672 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
5673 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
5674 else
5675 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
5676
5677 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
5678 bar->dragging = -1;
5679 bar->last_seen_part = part;
5680 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height,
5681 bar->horizontal);
5682 }
5683 }
5684
5685 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
5686
5687 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
5688 #define SCROLL_BAR_HORIZONTAL_NAME "horizontalScrollBar"
5689
5690 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
5691 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
5692
5693 #ifdef USE_GTK
5694 static void
5695 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
5696 {
5697 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
5698
5699 block_input ();
5700 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
5701 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
5702 scroll_bar_name);
5703 unblock_input ();
5704 }
5705
5706 static void
5707 x_create_horizontal_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
5708 {
5709 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_HORIZONTAL_NAME;
5710
5711 block_input ();
5712 xg_create_horizontal_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
5713 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
5714 scroll_bar_name);
5715 unblock_input ();
5716 }
5717
5718 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5719
5720 static void
5721 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
5722 {
5723 Window xwindow;
5724 Widget widget;
5725 Arg av[20];
5726 int ac = 0;
5727 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
5728 unsigned long pixel;
5729
5730 block_input ();
5731
5732 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
5733 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
5734 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
5735 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
5736 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
5737 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
5738 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
5739 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
5740 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
5741
5742 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
5743 if (pixel != -1)
5744 {
5745 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
5746 ++ac;
5747 }
5748
5749 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
5750 if (pixel != -1)
5751 {
5752 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
5753 ++ac;
5754 }
5755
5756 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
5757 (char *) scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
5758
5759 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
5760 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
5761 (XtPointer) bar);
5762 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
5763 (XtPointer) bar);
5764 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
5765 (XtPointer) bar);
5766 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
5767 (XtPointer) bar);
5768 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
5769 (XtPointer) bar);
5770 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
5771 (XtPointer) bar);
5772 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
5773 (XtPointer) bar);
5774
5775 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
5776 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
5777
5778 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
5779 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
5780 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
5781 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
5782
5783 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
5784
5785 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
5786 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
5787 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
5788 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
5789 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
5790 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
5791 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
5792 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
5793
5794 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
5795 if (pixel != -1)
5796 {
5797 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
5798 ++ac;
5799 }
5800
5801 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
5802 if (pixel != -1)
5803 {
5804 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
5805 ++ac;
5806 }
5807
5808 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
5809
5810 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
5811 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
5812 {
5813 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
5814 if (pixel != -1)
5815 {
5816 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5817 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
5818 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
5819 pixel = -1;
5820 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
5821 }
5822 }
5823 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
5824 {
5825 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
5826 if (pixel != -1)
5827 {
5828 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5829 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
5830 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
5831 pixel = -1;
5832 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
5833 }
5834 }
5835
5836 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
5837 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
5838 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
5839 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
5840 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
5841 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
5842 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
5843 colors itself. */
5844 {
5845 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
5846 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
5847 ++ac;
5848 }
5849 else
5850 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
5851 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
5852 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
5853 {
5854 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
5855 the shadows. */
5856 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
5857 ++ac;
5858
5859 /* Specify the colors. */
5860 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
5861 if (pixel != -1)
5862 {
5863 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
5864 ++ac;
5865 }
5866 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
5867 if (pixel != -1)
5868 {
5869 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
5870 ++ac;
5871 }
5872 }
5873 #endif
5874
5875 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
5876 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
5877
5878 {
5879 char const *initial = "";
5880 char const *val = initial;
5881 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
5882 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
5883 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
5884 #endif
5885 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
5886 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
5887 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
5888 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
5889 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
5890 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
5891 }
5892 }
5893
5894 /* Define callbacks. */
5895 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
5896 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
5897 (XtPointer) bar);
5898
5899 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
5900 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
5901
5902 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
5903
5904 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
5905 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
5906 if (action_hook_id == 0)
5907 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
5908
5909 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
5910 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
5911 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
5912 bar->x_window = xwindow;
5913 bar->whole = 1;
5914 bar->horizontal = false;
5915
5916 unblock_input ();
5917 }
5918
5919 static void
5920 x_create_horizontal_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
5921 {
5922 Window xwindow;
5923 Widget widget;
5924 Arg av[20];
5925 int ac = 0;
5926 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_HORIZONTAL_NAME;
5927 unsigned long pixel;
5928
5929 block_input ();
5930
5931 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
5932 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
5933 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
5934 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
5935 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
5936 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmHORIZONTAL); ++ac;
5937 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_RIGHT), ++ac;
5938 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
5939 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
5940
5941 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
5942 if (pixel != -1)
5943 {
5944 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
5945 ++ac;
5946 }
5947
5948 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
5949 if (pixel != -1)
5950 {
5951 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
5952 ++ac;
5953 }
5954
5955 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
5956 (char *) scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
5957
5958 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
5959 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
5960 (XtPointer) bar);
5961 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
5962 (XtPointer) bar);
5963 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
5964 (XtPointer) bar);
5965 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
5966 (XtPointer) bar);
5967 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
5968 (XtPointer) bar);
5969 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
5970 (XtPointer) bar);
5971 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
5972 (XtPointer) bar);
5973
5974 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
5975 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
5976
5977 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
5978 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
5979 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
5980 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
5981
5982 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
5983
5984 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
5985 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
5986 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
5987 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
5988 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
5989 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientHorizontal); ++ac;
5990 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
5991 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
5992
5993 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
5994 if (pixel != -1)
5995 {
5996 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
5997 ++ac;
5998 }
5999
6000 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
6001 if (pixel != -1)
6002 {
6003 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
6004 ++ac;
6005 }
6006
6007 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
6008
6009 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
6010 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
6011 {
6012 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
6013 if (pixel != -1)
6014 {
6015 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
6016 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
6017 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
6018 pixel = -1;
6019 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
6020 }
6021 }
6022 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
6023 {
6024 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
6025 if (pixel != -1)
6026 {
6027 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
6028 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
6029 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
6030 pixel = -1;
6031 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
6032 }
6033 }
6034
6035 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
6036 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
6037 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
6038 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
6039 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
6040 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
6041 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
6042 colors itself. */
6043 {
6044 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
6045 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
6046 ++ac;
6047 }
6048 else
6049 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
6050 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
6051 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
6052 {
6053 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
6054 the shadows. */
6055 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
6056 ++ac;
6057
6058 /* Specify the colors. */
6059 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
6060 if (pixel != -1)
6061 {
6062 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
6063 ++ac;
6064 }
6065 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
6066 if (pixel != -1)
6067 {
6068 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
6069 ++ac;
6070 }
6071 }
6072 #endif
6073
6074 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
6075 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
6076
6077 {
6078 char const *initial = "";
6079 char const *val = initial;
6080 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
6081 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
6082 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
6083 #endif
6084 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
6085 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
6086 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
6087 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
6088 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
6089 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
6090 }
6091 }
6092
6093 /* Define callbacks. */
6094 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
6095 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
6096 (XtPointer) bar);
6097
6098 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
6099 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
6100
6101 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
6102
6103 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
6104 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
6105 if (horizontal_action_hook_id == 0)
6106 horizontal_action_hook_id
6107 = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_horizontal_action_hook, 0);
6108
6109 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
6110 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
6111 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
6112 bar->x_window = xwindow;
6113 bar->whole = 1;
6114 bar->horizontal = true;
6115
6116 unblock_input ();
6117 }
6118 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6119
6120
6121 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
6122 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
6123
6124 #ifdef USE_GTK
6125 static void
6126 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
6127 {
6128 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
6129 }
6130
6131 static void
6132 x_set_toolkit_horizontal_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
6133 {
6134 xg_set_toolkit_horizontal_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
6135 }
6136
6137 #else /* not USE_GTK */
6138 static void
6139 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
6140 int whole)
6141 {
6142 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
6143 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
6144 float top, shown;
6145
6146 block_input ();
6147
6148 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
6149
6150 if (scroll_bar_adjust_thumb_portion_p)
6151 {
6152 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
6153 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
6154 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
6155 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
6156 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
6157 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
6158 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
6159 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
6160 its size, the update will often happen too late.
6161 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
6162 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
6163 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
6164 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
6165 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
6166 whole += portion;
6167 }
6168
6169 if (whole <= 0)
6170 top = 0, shown = 1;
6171 else
6172 {
6173 top = (float) position / whole;
6174 shown = (float) portion / whole;
6175 }
6176
6177 if (bar->dragging == -1)
6178 {
6179 int size, value;
6180
6181 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
6182 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
6183 value. */
6184 size = clip_to_bounds (1, shown * XM_SB_MAX, XM_SB_MAX);
6185
6186 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
6187 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
6188 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
6189
6190 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
6191 }
6192 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
6193
6194 if (whole == 0)
6195 top = 0, shown = 1;
6196 else
6197 {
6198 top = (float) position / whole;
6199 shown = (float) portion / whole;
6200 }
6201
6202 {
6203 float old_top, old_shown;
6204 Dimension height;
6205 XtVaGetValues (widget,
6206 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
6207 XtNshown, &old_shown,
6208 XtNheight, &height,
6209 NULL);
6210
6211 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
6212 if (bar->dragging == -1 || bar->last_seen_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
6213 top = max (0, min (1, top));
6214 else
6215 top = old_top;
6216 #if ! defined (HAVE_XAW3D)
6217 /* With Xaw, 'top' values too closer to 1.0 may
6218 cause the thumb to disappear. Fix that. */
6219 top = min (top, 0.99f);
6220 #endif
6221 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
6222 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0f / height), shown));
6223 #if ! defined (HAVE_XAW3D)
6224 /* Likewise with too small 'shown'. */
6225 shown = max (shown, 0.01f);
6226 #endif
6227
6228 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to
6229 work, check that 'NARROWPROTO' is defined in src/config.h.
6230 If this is not so, most likely you need to fix configure. */
6231 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
6232 {
6233 if (bar->dragging == -1)
6234 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
6235 else
6236 {
6237 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
6238 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
6239 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
6240
6241 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
6242 }
6243 }
6244 }
6245 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
6246
6247 unblock_input ();
6248 }
6249
6250 static void
6251 x_set_toolkit_horizontal_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
6252 int whole)
6253 {
6254 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
6255 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
6256 float top, shown;
6257
6258 block_input ();
6259
6260 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
6261 bar->whole = whole;
6262 shown = (float) portion / whole;
6263 top = (float) position / (whole - portion);
6264 {
6265 int size = clip_to_bounds (1, shown * XM_SB_MAX, XM_SB_MAX);
6266 int value = clip_to_bounds (0, top * (XM_SB_MAX - size), XM_SB_MAX - size);
6267
6268 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
6269 }
6270 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
6271 bar->whole = whole;
6272 if (whole == 0)
6273 top = 0, shown = 1;
6274 else
6275 {
6276 top = (float) position / whole;
6277 shown = (float) portion / whole;
6278 }
6279
6280 {
6281 float old_top, old_shown;
6282 Dimension height;
6283 XtVaGetValues (widget,
6284 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
6285 XtNshown, &old_shown,
6286 XtNheight, &height,
6287 NULL);
6288
6289 #if false
6290 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
6291 if (bar->dragging == -1 || bar->last_seen_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
6292 top = max (0, min (1, top));
6293 else
6294 top = old_top;
6295 #if ! defined (HAVE_XAW3D)
6296 /* With Xaw, 'top' values too closer to 1.0 may
6297 cause the thumb to disappear. Fix that. */
6298 top = min (top, 0.99f);
6299 #endif
6300 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
6301 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0f / height), shown));
6302 #if ! defined (HAVE_XAW3D)
6303 /* Likewise with too small 'shown'. */
6304 shown = max (shown, 0.01f);
6305 #endif
6306 #endif
6307
6308 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to
6309 work, check that 'NARROWPROTO' is defined in src/config.h.
6310 If this is not so, most likely you need to fix configure. */
6311 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
6312 #if false
6313 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
6314 {
6315 if (bar->dragging == -1)
6316 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
6317 else
6318 {
6319 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
6320 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
6321 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
6322
6323 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
6324 }
6325 }
6326 #endif
6327 }
6328 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
6329
6330 unblock_input ();
6331 }
6332 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6333
6334 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6335
6336
6337 \f
6338 /************************************************************************
6339 Scroll bars, general
6340 ************************************************************************/
6341
6342 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
6343 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
6344 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
6345 scroll bar. */
6346
6347 static struct scroll_bar *
6348 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left,
6349 int width, int height, bool horizontal)
6350 {
6351 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
6352 struct scroll_bar *bar
6353 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
6354 Lisp_Object barobj;
6355
6356 block_input ();
6357
6358 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6359 if (horizontal)
6360 x_create_horizontal_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
6361 else
6362 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
6363 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6364 {
6365 XSetWindowAttributes a;
6366 unsigned long mask;
6367 Window window;
6368
6369 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
6370 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
6371 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
6372
6373 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
6374 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
6375 | ExposureMask);
6376 a.cursor = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
6377
6378 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
6379
6380 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
6381 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
6382 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
6383 if (width > 0 && window_box_height (w) > 0)
6384 x_clear_area (f, left, top, width, window_box_height (w));
6385
6386 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
6387 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
6388 left, top, width, height,
6389 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
6390 0,
6391 CopyFromParent,
6392 CopyFromParent,
6393 CopyFromParent,
6394 /* Attributes. */
6395 mask, &a);
6396 bar->x_window = window;
6397 }
6398 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6399
6400 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
6401 bar->top = top;
6402 bar->left = left;
6403 bar->width = width;
6404 bar->height = height;
6405 bar->start = 0;
6406 bar->end = 0;
6407 bar->dragging = -1;
6408 bar->horizontal = horizontal;
6409 #if defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS) && defined (USE_LUCID)
6410 bar->last_seen_part = scroll_bar_nowhere;
6411 #endif
6412
6413 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
6414 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
6415 bar->prev = Qnil;
6416 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
6417 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
6418 if (!NILP (bar->next))
6419 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
6420
6421 /* Map the window/widget. */
6422 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6423 {
6424 #ifdef USE_GTK
6425 if (horizontal)
6426 xg_update_horizontal_scrollbar_pos (f, bar->x_window, top,
6427 left, width, max (height, 1));
6428 else
6429 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f, bar->x_window, top,
6430 left, width, max (height, 1));
6431 #else /* not USE_GTK */
6432 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
6433 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar, left, top, width, max (height, 1), 0);
6434 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
6435 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6436 }
6437 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6438 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
6439 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6440
6441 unblock_input ();
6442 return bar;
6443 }
6444
6445
6446 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6447
6448 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
6449
6450 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
6451 redrawing it, unless REBUILD; in that case, always
6452 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
6453 events.)
6454
6455 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
6456 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
6457 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
6458 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
6459 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
6460
6461 static void
6462 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end,
6463 bool rebuild)
6464 {
6465 bool dragging = bar->dragging != -1;
6466 Window w = bar->x_window;
6467 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
6468 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
6469
6470 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
6471 if (! rebuild
6472 && start == bar->start
6473 && end == bar->end)
6474 return;
6475
6476 block_input ();
6477
6478 {
6479 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
6480 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
6481 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
6482
6483 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
6484 the distance between start and end. */
6485 {
6486 int length = end - start;
6487
6488 if (start < 0)
6489 start = 0;
6490 else if (start > top_range)
6491 start = top_range;
6492 end = start + length;
6493
6494 if (end < start)
6495 end = start;
6496 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
6497 end = top_range;
6498 }
6499
6500 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
6501 bar->start = start;
6502 bar->end = end;
6503
6504 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
6505 if (end > top_range)
6506 end = top_range;
6507
6508 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
6509 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
6510 that many pixels tall. */
6511 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
6512
6513 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
6514 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
6515 if ((inside_width > 0) && (start > 0))
6516 x_clear_area1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
6517 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
6518 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
6519 inside_width, start, False);
6520
6521 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
6522 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
6523 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
6524 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
6525
6526 /* Draw the handle itself. */
6527 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
6528 /* x, y, width, height */
6529 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
6530 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
6531 inside_width, end - start);
6532
6533 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
6534 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
6535 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
6536 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
6537
6538 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
6539 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
6540 if ((inside_width > 0) && (end < inside_height))
6541 x_clear_area1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
6542 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
6543 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
6544 inside_width, inside_height - end, False);
6545 }
6546
6547 unblock_input ();
6548 }
6549
6550 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6551
6552 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
6553 nil. */
6554
6555 static void
6556 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
6557 {
6558 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
6559 block_input ();
6560
6561 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6562 #ifdef USE_GTK
6563 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
6564 #else /* not USE_GTK */
6565 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
6566 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6567 #else
6568 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
6569 #endif
6570
6571 /* Dissociate this scroll bar from its window. */
6572 if (bar->horizontal)
6573 wset_horizontal_scroll_bar (XWINDOW (bar->window), Qnil);
6574 else
6575 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (XWINDOW (bar->window), Qnil);
6576
6577 unblock_input ();
6578 }
6579
6580
6581 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
6582 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
6583 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
6584 create one. */
6585
6586 static void
6587 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
6588 {
6589 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
6590 Lisp_Object barobj;
6591 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6592 int top, height, left, width;
6593 int window_y, window_height;
6594
6595 /* Get window dimensions. */
6596 window_box (w, ANY_AREA, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
6597 top = window_y;
6598 height = window_height;
6599 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
6600 width = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (w);
6601
6602 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
6603 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
6604 {
6605 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
6606 {
6607 block_input ();
6608 x_clear_area (f, left, top, width, height);
6609 unblock_input ();
6610 }
6611
6612 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, max (height, 1), false);
6613 }
6614 else
6615 {
6616 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
6617 unsigned int mask = 0;
6618
6619 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
6620
6621 block_input ();
6622
6623 if (left != bar->left)
6624 mask |= CWX;
6625 if (top != bar->top)
6626 mask |= CWY;
6627 if (width != bar->width)
6628 mask |= CWWidth;
6629 if (height != bar->height)
6630 mask |= CWHeight;
6631
6632 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6633
6634 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
6635 if (mask)
6636 {
6637 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
6638 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
6639 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
6640 x_clear_area (f, left, top, width, height);
6641 #ifdef USE_GTK
6642 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f, bar->x_window, top,
6643 left, width, max (height, 1));
6644 #else /* not USE_GTK */
6645 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
6646 left, top, width, max (height, 1), 0);
6647 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6648 }
6649 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6650
6651 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
6652 if (mask)
6653 {
6654 XWindowChanges wc;
6655
6656 wc.x = left;
6657 wc.y = top;
6658 wc.width = width;
6659 wc.height = height;
6660 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
6661 mask, &wc);
6662 }
6663
6664 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6665
6666 /* Remember new settings. */
6667 bar->left = left;
6668 bar->top = top;
6669 bar->width = width;
6670 bar->height = height;
6671
6672 unblock_input ();
6673 }
6674
6675 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6676 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
6677 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6678 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
6679 dragged. */
6680 if (bar->dragging == -1)
6681 {
6682 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
6683
6684 if (whole == 0)
6685 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, false);
6686 else
6687 {
6688 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
6689 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
6690 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, false);
6691 }
6692 }
6693 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6694
6695 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
6696 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, barobj);
6697 }
6698
6699
6700 static void
6701 XTset_horizontal_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
6702 {
6703 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
6704 Lisp_Object barobj;
6705 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6706 int top, height, left, width;
6707 int window_x, window_width;
6708 int pixel_width = WINDOW_PIXEL_WIDTH (w);
6709
6710 /* Get window dimensions. */
6711 window_box (w, ANY_AREA, &window_x, 0, &window_width, 0);
6712 left = window_x;
6713 width = window_width;
6714 top = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_Y (w);
6715 height = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_HEIGHT (w);
6716
6717 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
6718 if (NILP (w->horizontal_scroll_bar))
6719 {
6720 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
6721 {
6722 block_input ();
6723
6724 /* Clear also part between window_width and
6725 WINDOW_PIXEL_WIDTH. */
6726 x_clear_area (f, left, top, pixel_width, height);
6727 unblock_input ();
6728 }
6729
6730 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height, true);
6731 }
6732 else
6733 {
6734 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
6735 unsigned int mask = 0;
6736
6737 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->horizontal_scroll_bar);
6738
6739 block_input ();
6740
6741 if (left != bar->left)
6742 mask |= CWX;
6743 if (top != bar->top)
6744 mask |= CWY;
6745 if (width != bar->width)
6746 mask |= CWWidth;
6747 if (height != bar->height)
6748 mask |= CWHeight;
6749
6750 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6751 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
6752 if (mask)
6753 {
6754 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
6755 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
6756 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
6757 x_clear_area (f,
6758 WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_X (w), top,
6759 pixel_width - WINDOW_RIGHT_DIVIDER_WIDTH (w), height);
6760 #ifdef USE_GTK
6761 xg_update_horizontal_scrollbar_pos (f, bar->x_window, top, left,
6762 width, height);
6763 #else /* not USE_GTK */
6764 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
6765 left, top, width, height, 0);
6766 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6767 }
6768 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6769
6770 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
6771 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
6772 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
6773 example. */
6774 {
6775 int area_height = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_HEIGHT (w);
6776 int rest = area_height - height;
6777 if (rest > 0 && width > 0)
6778 x_clear_area (f, left, top, width, rest);
6779 }
6780
6781 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
6782 if (mask)
6783 {
6784 XWindowChanges wc;
6785
6786 wc.x = left;
6787 wc.y = top;
6788 wc.width = width;
6789 wc.height = height;
6790 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
6791 mask, &wc);
6792 }
6793
6794 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6795
6796 /* Remember new settings. */
6797 bar->left = left;
6798 bar->top = top;
6799 bar->width = width;
6800 bar->height = height;
6801
6802 unblock_input ();
6803 }
6804
6805 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6806 x_set_toolkit_horizontal_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
6807 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6808 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
6809 dragged. */
6810 if (bar->dragging == -1)
6811 {
6812 int left_range = HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_RANGE (f, width);
6813
6814 if (whole == 0)
6815 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, left_range, false);
6816 else
6817 {
6818 int start = ((double) position * left_range) / whole;
6819 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * left_range) / whole;
6820 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, false);
6821 }
6822 }
6823 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6824
6825 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
6826 wset_horizontal_scroll_bar (w, barobj);
6827 }
6828
6829
6830 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
6831 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
6832 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
6833 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
6834 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
6835 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
6836 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
6837
6838 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
6839 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
6840 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
6841
6842 static void
6843 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (struct frame *frame)
6844 {
6845 if (!NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
6846 {
6847 if (!NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
6848 {
6849 /* Prepend scrollbars to already condemned ones. */
6850 Lisp_Object last = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
6851
6852 while (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (last)->next))
6853 last = XSCROLL_BAR (last)->next;
6854
6855 XSCROLL_BAR (last)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
6856 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = last;
6857 }
6858
6859 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (frame, FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame));
6860 fset_scroll_bars (frame, Qnil);
6861 }
6862 }
6863
6864
6865 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
6866 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
6867
6868 static void
6869 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *w)
6870 {
6871 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6872 Lisp_Object barobj;
6873 struct frame *f;
6874
6875 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
6876 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar) && NILP (w->horizontal_scroll_bar))
6877 emacs_abort ();
6878
6879 if (!NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar) && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR (w))
6880 {
6881 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
6882 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
6883 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
6884 if (NILP (bar->prev))
6885 {
6886 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
6887 the lists. */
6888 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), w->vertical_scroll_bar))
6889 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
6890 goto horizontal;
6891 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
6892 w->vertical_scroll_bar))
6893 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, bar->next);
6894 else
6895 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
6896 one or the other! */
6897 emacs_abort ();
6898 }
6899 else
6900 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
6901
6902 if (! NILP (bar->next))
6903 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
6904
6905 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
6906 bar->prev = Qnil;
6907 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
6908 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
6909 if (! NILP (bar->next))
6910 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
6911 }
6912
6913 horizontal:
6914 if (!NILP (w->horizontal_scroll_bar) && WINDOW_HAS_HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR (w))
6915 {
6916 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->horizontal_scroll_bar);
6917 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
6918 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
6919 if (NILP (bar->prev))
6920 {
6921 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
6922 the lists. */
6923 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), w->horizontal_scroll_bar))
6924 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
6925 return;
6926 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
6927 w->horizontal_scroll_bar))
6928 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, bar->next);
6929 else
6930 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
6931 one or the other! */
6932 emacs_abort ();
6933 }
6934 else
6935 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
6936
6937 if (! NILP (bar->next))
6938 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
6939
6940 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
6941 bar->prev = Qnil;
6942 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
6943 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
6944 if (! NILP (bar->next))
6945 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
6946 }
6947 }
6948
6949 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
6950 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
6951
6952 static void
6953 XTjudge_scroll_bars (struct frame *f)
6954 {
6955 Lisp_Object bar, next;
6956
6957 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
6958
6959 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
6960 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
6961 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, Qnil);
6962
6963 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
6964 {
6965 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
6966
6967 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
6968
6969 next = b->next;
6970 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
6971 }
6972
6973 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
6974 and they should get garbage-collected. */
6975 }
6976
6977
6978 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6979 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
6980 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
6981
6982 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
6983 mark bits. */
6984
6985 static void
6986 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, const XEvent *event)
6987 {
6988 Window w = bar->x_window;
6989 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
6990 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
6991
6992 block_input ();
6993
6994 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, true);
6995
6996 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
6997 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
6998 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
6999 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
7000
7001 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
7002 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
7003 /* x, y, width, height */
7004 0, 0, bar->width - 1, bar->height - 1);
7005
7006 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
7007 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
7008 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
7009 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
7010
7011 unblock_input ();
7012
7013 }
7014 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
7015
7016 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
7017 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
7018
7019 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
7020 mark bits. */
7021
7022
7023 static void
7024 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar,
7025 const XEvent *event,
7026 struct input_event *emacs_event)
7027 {
7028 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
7029 emacs_abort ();
7030
7031 emacs_event->kind = (bar->horizontal
7032 ? HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT
7033 : SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT);
7034 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
7035 emacs_event->modifiers
7036 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO
7037 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
7038 event->xbutton.state)
7039 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
7040 ? up_modifier
7041 : down_modifier));
7042 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
7043 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
7044 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
7045 if (bar->horizontal)
7046 {
7047 int left_range
7048 = HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_RANGE (f, bar->width);
7049 int x = event->xbutton.x - HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER;
7050
7051 if (x < 0) x = 0;
7052 if (x > left_range) x = left_range;
7053
7054 if (x < bar->start)
7055 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_before_handle;
7056 else if (x < bar->end + HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
7057 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_horizontal_handle;
7058 else
7059 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_after_handle;
7060
7061 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
7062 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
7063 if (event->type == ButtonRelease && bar->dragging != -1)
7064 {
7065 int new_start = - bar->dragging;
7066 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
7067
7068 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, false);
7069 bar->dragging = -1;
7070 }
7071 #endif
7072
7073 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, left_range);
7074 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, x);
7075 }
7076 else
7077 {
7078 int top_range
7079 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
7080 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
7081
7082 if (y < 0) y = 0;
7083 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
7084
7085 if (y < bar->start)
7086 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
7087 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
7088 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
7089 else
7090 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
7091
7092 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
7093 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
7094 if (event->type == ButtonRelease && bar->dragging != -1)
7095 {
7096 int new_start = y - bar->dragging;
7097 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
7098
7099 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, false);
7100 bar->dragging = -1;
7101 }
7102 #endif
7103
7104 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
7105 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
7106 }
7107 }
7108
7109 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
7110
7111 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
7112
7113 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
7114 mark bits. */
7115
7116 static void
7117 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar,
7118 const XMotionEvent *event)
7119 {
7120 struct frame *f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
7121 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7122
7123 dpyinfo->last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
7124 dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar = bar;
7125 f->mouse_moved = true;
7126
7127 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
7128 if (bar->dragging != -1)
7129 {
7130 /* Where should the handle be now? */
7131 int new_start = event->y - bar->dragging;
7132
7133 if (new_start != bar->start)
7134 {
7135 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
7136
7137 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, false);
7138 }
7139 }
7140 }
7141
7142 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
7143
7144 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
7145 on the scroll bar. */
7146
7147 static void
7148 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
7149 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
7150 Lisp_Object *y, Time *timestamp)
7151 {
7152 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp);
7153 struct scroll_bar *bar = dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar;
7154 Window w = bar->x_window;
7155 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
7156 int win_x, win_y;
7157 Window dummy_window;
7158 int dummy_coord;
7159 unsigned int dummy_mask;
7160
7161 block_input ();
7162
7163 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
7164 report that. */
7165 if (XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
7166
7167 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
7168 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
7169 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
7170
7171 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
7172 &win_x, &win_y,
7173
7174 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
7175 &dummy_mask))
7176 {
7177 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
7178
7179 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
7180
7181 if (bar->dragging != -1)
7182 win_y -= bar->dragging;
7183
7184 if (win_y < 0)
7185 win_y = 0;
7186 if (win_y > top_range)
7187 win_y = top_range;
7188
7189 *fp = f;
7190 *bar_window = bar->window;
7191
7192 if (bar->dragging != -1)
7193 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
7194 else if (win_y < bar->start)
7195 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
7196 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
7197 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
7198 else
7199 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
7200
7201 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
7202 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
7203
7204 f->mouse_moved = false;
7205 dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar = NULL;
7206 *timestamp = dpyinfo->last_mouse_movement_time;
7207 }
7208
7209 unblock_input ();
7210 }
7211
7212
7213 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
7214 on the scroll bar. */
7215
7216 static void
7217 x_horizontal_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
7218 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
7219 Lisp_Object *y, Time *timestamp)
7220 {
7221 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp);
7222 struct scroll_bar *bar = dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar;
7223 Window w = bar->x_window;
7224 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
7225 int win_x, win_y;
7226 Window dummy_window;
7227 int dummy_coord;
7228 unsigned int dummy_mask;
7229
7230 block_input ();
7231
7232 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
7233 report that. */
7234 if (XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
7235
7236 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
7237 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
7238 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
7239
7240 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
7241 &win_x, &win_y,
7242
7243 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
7244 &dummy_mask))
7245 {
7246 int left_range = HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_RANGE (f, bar->width);
7247
7248 win_x -= HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER;
7249
7250 if (bar->dragging != -1)
7251 win_x -= bar->dragging;
7252
7253 if (win_x < 0)
7254 win_x = 0;
7255 if (win_x > left_range)
7256 win_x = left_range;
7257
7258 *fp = f;
7259 *bar_window = bar->window;
7260
7261 if (bar->dragging != -1)
7262 *part = scroll_bar_horizontal_handle;
7263 else if (win_x < bar->start)
7264 *part = scroll_bar_before_handle;
7265 else if (win_x < bar->end + HORIZONTAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
7266 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
7267 else
7268 *part = scroll_bar_after_handle;
7269
7270 XSETINT (*y, win_x);
7271 XSETINT (*x, left_range);
7272
7273 f->mouse_moved = false;
7274 dpyinfo->last_mouse_scroll_bar = NULL;
7275 *timestamp = dpyinfo->last_mouse_movement_time;
7276 }
7277
7278 unblock_input ();
7279 }
7280
7281
7282 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
7283 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
7284 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
7285 redraw them. */
7286
7287 static void
7288 x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *f)
7289 {
7290 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
7291 Lisp_Object bar;
7292
7293 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
7294 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
7295 But in that case we should not clear them. */
7296 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
7297 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
7298 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
7299 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
7300 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
7301 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
7302 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
7303 }
7304
7305 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
7306
7307 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
7308 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
7309
7310 static int temp_index;
7311 static short temp_buffer[100];
7312
7313 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
7314 if (temp_index == ARRAYELTS (temp_buffer)) \
7315 temp_index = 0; \
7316 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
7317
7318 #else /* not ENABLE_CHECKING */
7319
7320 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) ((void)0)
7321
7322 #endif /* ENABLE_CHECKING */
7323
7324 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
7325 on a particular display. */
7326
7327 static struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
7328
7329 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
7330 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
7331 We try all the open displays, one by one.
7332 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
7333
7334 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
7335
7336 enum
7337 {
7338 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
7339 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
7340 X_EVENT_DROP
7341 };
7342
7343 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
7344 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
7345 EVENT is the X event to filter.
7346
7347 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
7348 this event further.
7349 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
7350
7351 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7352 static int
7353 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
7354 {
7355 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
7356 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
7357 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
7358 was created. */
7359
7360 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
7361 event->xclient.window);
7362
7363 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
7364 }
7365 #endif
7366
7367 #ifdef USE_GTK
7368 static int current_count;
7369 static int current_finish;
7370 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
7371
7372 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
7373 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
7374 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
7375 static GdkFilterReturn
7376 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
7377 {
7378 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
7379
7380 block_input ();
7381 if (current_count >= 0)
7382 {
7383 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7384
7385 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
7386
7387 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7388 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
7389 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
7390 so we do it here. */
7391 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
7392 && dpyinfo
7393 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
7394 {
7395 unblock_input ();
7396 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
7397 }
7398 #endif
7399
7400 if (! dpyinfo)
7401 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7402 else
7403 current_count
7404 += handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
7405 current_hold_quit);
7406 }
7407 else
7408 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
7409
7410 unblock_input ();
7411
7412 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
7413 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
7414
7415 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
7416 }
7417 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7418
7419
7420 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time,
7421 enum xembed_message,
7422 long detail, long data1, long data2);
7423
7424 static void
7425 x_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, Window window)
7426 {
7427 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
7428 Lisp_Object lval = Qnil;
7429 bool sticky = false;
7430
7431 get_current_wm_state (f, window, &value, &sticky);
7432
7433 switch (value)
7434 {
7435 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
7436 lval = Qfullwidth;
7437 break;
7438 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
7439 lval = Qfullheight;
7440 break;
7441 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
7442 lval = Qfullboth;
7443 break;
7444 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
7445 lval = Qmaximized;
7446 break;
7447 }
7448
7449 frame_size_history_add
7450 (f, Qx_net_wm_state, 0, 0,
7451 list2 (get_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen), lval));
7452
7453 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
7454 /** store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil); **/
7455 }
7456
7457 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
7458
7459 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
7460 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
7461 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
7462 *EVENT is unchanged unless we're processing KeyPress event.
7463
7464 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
7465
7466 static int
7467 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo,
7468 const XEvent *event,
7469 int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7470 {
7471 union buffered_input_event inev;
7472 int count = 0;
7473 int do_help = 0;
7474 ptrdiff_t nbytes = 0;
7475 struct frame *any, *f = NULL;
7476 struct coding_system coding;
7477 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
7478 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
7479 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
7480 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
7481 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay. */
7482 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
7483
7484 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
7485
7486 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7487
7488 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
7489 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
7490 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
7491
7492 any = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
7493
7494 if (any && any->wait_event_type == event->type)
7495 any->wait_event_type = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
7496
7497 switch (event->type)
7498 {
7499 case ClientMessage:
7500 {
7501 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
7502 && event->xclient.format == 32)
7503 {
7504 if (event->xclient.data.l[0] == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
7505 {
7506 /* Use the value returned by x_any_window_to_frame
7507 because this could be the shell widget window
7508 if the frame has no title bar. */
7509 f = any;
7510 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7511 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
7512 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
7513 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
7514 #endif
7515 #if false
7516 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
7517 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
7518 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
7519 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
7520 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
7521 needed.
7522
7523 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
7524 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
7525 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
7526 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
7527 Emacs. */
7528
7529 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
7530 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
7531 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
7532 if (f)
7533 {
7534 Display *d = event->xclient.display;
7535 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
7536 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
7537 x_catch_errors (d);
7538 XSetInputFocus (d, event->xclient.window,
7539 /* The ICCCM says this is
7540 the only valid choice. */
7541 RevertToParent,
7542 event->xclient.data.l[1]);
7543 x_uncatch_errors ();
7544 }
7545 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
7546 #endif
7547 goto done;
7548 }
7549
7550 if (event->xclient.data.l[0] == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
7551 {
7552 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
7553 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
7554 the session manager, who's looking for such a
7555 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
7556 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
7557 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
7558 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
7559 session manager and one for this. */
7560 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
7561 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
7562 #endif
7563 {
7564 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
7565 event->xclient.window);
7566 /* This is just so we only give real data once
7567 for a single Emacs process. */
7568 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
7569 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
7570 event->xclient.window,
7571 initial_argv, initial_argc);
7572 else if (f)
7573 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
7574 event->xclient.window,
7575 0, 0);
7576 }
7577 goto done;
7578 }
7579
7580 if (event->xclient.data.l[0] == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
7581 {
7582 f = any;
7583 if (!f)
7584 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
7585
7586 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
7587 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
7588 goto done;
7589 }
7590
7591 goto done;
7592 }
7593
7594 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
7595 goto done;
7596
7597 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
7598 {
7599 int new_x, new_y;
7600 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xclient.window);
7601
7602 new_x = event->xclient.data.s[0];
7603 new_y = event->xclient.data.s[1];
7604
7605 if (f)
7606 {
7607 f->left_pos = new_x;
7608 f->top_pos = new_y;
7609 }
7610 goto done;
7611 }
7612
7613 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
7614 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
7615 {
7616 f = any;
7617 if (f)
7618 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget,
7619 NULL, (XEvent *) event, NULL);
7620 goto done;
7621 }
7622 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
7623
7624 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE
7625 || event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE)
7626 {
7627 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
7628 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
7629 currently never do because we are interested in
7630 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
7631 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event->xclient.data.l[1];
7632 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xclient.window);
7633 if (!f)
7634 goto OTHER;
7635 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
7636 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
7637 goto done;
7638 }
7639
7640 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
7641 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
7642 we construct an input_event. */
7643 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
7644 {
7645 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, &inev.ie);
7646 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
7647 goto done;
7648 }
7649 else if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_Horizontal_Scrollbar)
7650 {
7651 x_horizontal_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, &inev.ie);
7652 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
7653 goto done;
7654 }
7655 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
7656
7657 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
7658 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
7659 {
7660 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
7661 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
7662 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, any, event, &inev.ie);
7663
7664 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
7665 goto done;
7666 }
7667
7668 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, event);
7669
7670 f = any;
7671 if (!f)
7672 goto OTHER;
7673 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event->xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
7674 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
7675 }
7676 break;
7677
7678 case SelectionNotify:
7679 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo, event->xselection.time);
7680 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7681 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xselection.requestor))
7682 goto OTHER;
7683 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7684 x_handle_selection_notify (&event->xselection);
7685 break;
7686
7687 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
7688 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo, event->xselectionclear.time);
7689 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7690 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xselectionclear.window))
7691 goto OTHER;
7692 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7693 {
7694 const XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = &event->xselectionclear;
7695
7696 inev.sie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
7697 SELECTION_EVENT_DPYINFO (&inev.sie) = dpyinfo;
7698 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
7699 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
7700 }
7701 break;
7702
7703 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
7704 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo, event->xselectionrequest.time);
7705 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7706 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xselectionrequest.owner))
7707 goto OTHER;
7708 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7709 {
7710 const XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp = &event->xselectionrequest;
7711
7712 inev.sie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
7713 SELECTION_EVENT_DPYINFO (&inev.sie) = dpyinfo;
7714 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
7715 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
7716 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
7717 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
7718 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
7719 }
7720 break;
7721
7722 case PropertyNotify:
7723 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo, event->xproperty.time);
7724 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xproperty.window);
7725 if (f && event->xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
7726 {
7727 bool not_hidden = x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event->xproperty);
7728 if (not_hidden && FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
7729 {
7730 /* Gnome shell does not iconify us when C-z is pressed.
7731 It hides the frame. So if our state says we aren't
7732 hidden anymore, treat it as deiconified. */
7733 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 1);
7734 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, false);
7735 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = true;
7736 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
7737 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
7738 }
7739 else if (! not_hidden && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
7740 {
7741 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
7742 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, true);
7743 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
7744 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
7745 }
7746 }
7747
7748 x_handle_property_notify (&event->xproperty);
7749 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, event);
7750 goto OTHER;
7751
7752 case ReparentNotify:
7753 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xreparent.window);
7754 if (f)
7755 {
7756 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event->xreparent.parent;
7757 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
7758
7759 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
7760 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
7761 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
7762
7763 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
7764 }
7765 goto OTHER;
7766
7767 case Expose:
7768 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xexpose.window);
7769 if (f)
7770 {
7771 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
7772 {
7773 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 1);
7774 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, false);
7775 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = true;
7776 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
7777 }
7778 else
7779 {
7780 #ifdef USE_GTK
7781 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6 and later, see
7782 http://debbugs.gnu.org/cgi/bugreport.cgi?bug=15398. */
7783 x_clear_area (f,
7784 event->xexpose.x, event->xexpose.y,
7785 event->xexpose.width, event->xexpose.height);
7786 #endif
7787 expose_frame (f, event->xexpose.x, event->xexpose.y,
7788 event->xexpose.width, event->xexpose.height);
7789 }
7790 }
7791 else
7792 {
7793 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
7794 struct scroll_bar *bar;
7795 #endif
7796 #if defined USE_LUCID
7797 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
7798 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
7799 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
7800 {
7801 Widget widget = x_window_to_menu_bar (event->xexpose.window);
7802 if (widget)
7803 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
7804 }
7805 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
7806
7807 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
7808 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
7809 goto OTHER;
7810 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
7811 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event->xexpose.display,
7812 event->xexpose.window, 2);
7813
7814 if (bar)
7815 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event);
7816 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7817 else
7818 goto OTHER;
7819 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7820 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
7821 }
7822 break;
7823
7824 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
7825 source area was obscured or not
7826 available. */
7827 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
7828 if (f)
7829 expose_frame (f, event->xgraphicsexpose.x,
7830 event->xgraphicsexpose.y,
7831 event->xgraphicsexpose.width,
7832 event->xgraphicsexpose.height);
7833 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7834 else
7835 goto OTHER;
7836 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7837 break;
7838
7839 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
7840 source area was completely
7841 available. */
7842 break;
7843
7844 case UnmapNotify:
7845 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
7846 if (event->xunmap.window == tip_window)
7847 {
7848 tip_window = 0;
7849 x_redo_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo);
7850 }
7851
7852 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xunmap.window);
7853 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
7854 the frame was deleted. */
7855 {
7856 bool visible = FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);
7857 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
7858 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
7859 display that won't ever be seen. */
7860 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
7861 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
7862 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
7863 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
7864 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
7865 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
7866 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
7867 if (visible || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
7868 {
7869 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, true);
7870 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
7871 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
7872 }
7873 }
7874 goto OTHER;
7875
7876 case MapNotify:
7877 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
7878 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
7879 frame is visible. */
7880 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xmap.window);
7881 if (f)
7882 {
7883 bool iconified = FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f);
7884
7885 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
7886 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
7887 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
7888 x_check_fullscreen (f);
7889
7890 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 1);
7891 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, false);
7892 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = true;
7893
7894 if (iconified)
7895 {
7896 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
7897 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
7898 }
7899 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list) && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
7900 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later to update the
7901 frame titles in case this is the second frame. */
7902 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
7903
7904 #ifdef USE_GTK
7905 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
7906 #endif
7907 }
7908 goto OTHER;
7909
7910 case KeyPress:
7911
7912 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo, event->xkey.time);
7913 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
7914
7915 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
7916 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
7917 if (popup_activated ())
7918 goto OTHER;
7919 #endif
7920
7921 f = any;
7922
7923 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
7924 mouse highlighting. */
7925 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
7926 #if ! defined (USE_GTK)
7927 && (f == 0
7928 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window))
7929 #endif
7930 )
7931 {
7932 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
7933 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = true;
7934 }
7935
7936 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
7937 if (f == 0)
7938 {
7939 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
7940 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
7941 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
7942 event->xkey.window);
7943 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
7944 {
7945 widget = XtParent (widget);
7946 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
7947 }
7948 }
7949 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
7950
7951 if (f != 0)
7952 {
7953 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
7954 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
7955 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
7956 his Emacs hang.
7957
7958 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
7959 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
7960 status_return even if the input is too long to
7961 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
7962 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
7963 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
7964 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
7965 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
7966 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
7967 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
7968 int modifiers;
7969 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
7970 Lisp_Object c;
7971 /* Event will be modified. */
7972 XKeyEvent xkey = event->xkey;
7973
7974 #ifdef USE_GTK
7975 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
7976 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
7977 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is nonzero
7978 (see above). */
7979 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
7980 #endif
7981
7982 xkey.state |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
7983 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
7984 modifiers = xkey.state;
7985
7986 /* This will have to go some day... */
7987
7988 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
7989 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
7990 xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
7991 xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
7992 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
7993 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
7994 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
7995
7996 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
7997 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
7998 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
7999 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
8000 not it is combined with Meta. */
8001 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
8002 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
8003
8004 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8005 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
8006 {
8007 Status status_return;
8008
8009 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
8010 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
8011 &xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
8012 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
8013 &status_return);
8014 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
8015 {
8016 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
8017 copy_bufptr = alloca (copy_bufsiz);
8018 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
8019 &xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
8020 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
8021 &status_return);
8022 }
8023 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
8024 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
8025 break;
8026 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
8027 {
8028 keysym = NoSymbol;
8029 modifiers = 0;
8030 }
8031 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
8032 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
8033 emacs_abort ();
8034 }
8035 else
8036 nbytes = XLookupString (&xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
8037 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
8038 &compose_status);
8039 #else
8040 nbytes = XLookupString (&xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
8041 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
8042 &compose_status);
8043 #endif
8044
8045 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
8046 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
8047 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
8048 break;
8049
8050 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
8051 orig_keysym = keysym;
8052
8053 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
8054 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
8055 inev.ie.modifiers
8056 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
8057 inev.ie.timestamp = xkey.time;
8058
8059 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
8060 translations to characters. */
8061 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
8062 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
8063 {
8064 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
8065 inev.ie.code = keysym;
8066 goto done_keysym;
8067 }
8068
8069 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
8070 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
8071 {
8072 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
8073 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
8074 else
8075 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
8076 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
8077 goto done_keysym;
8078 }
8079
8080 /* Now non-ASCII. */
8081 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
8082 && (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
8083 Vx_keysym_table,
8084 Qnil),
8085 NATNUMP (c)))
8086 {
8087 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
8088 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
8089 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
8090 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
8091 goto done_keysym;
8092 }
8093
8094 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
8095 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
8096 || keysym == XK_Delete
8097 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
8098 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
8099 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
8100 #endif
8101 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
8102 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
8103 #ifdef HPUX
8104 /* This recognizes the "extended function
8105 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
8106 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
8107 mode_switch incorrectly. */
8108 || (XK_Select <= keysym && keysym < XK_KP_Space)
8109 #endif
8110 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
8111 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
8112 #endif
8113 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
8114 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
8115 #endif
8116 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
8117 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
8118 #endif
8119 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
8120 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
8121 #endif
8122 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
8123 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
8124 #endif
8125 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
8126 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
8127 #endif
8128 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
8129 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
8130 #endif
8131 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
8132 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
8133 #endif
8134 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
8135 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
8136 #endif
8137 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
8138 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
8139 #endif
8140 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
8141 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
8142 #endif
8143 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
8144 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
8145 #endif
8146 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
8147 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
8148 #endif
8149 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
8150 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
8151 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
8152 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
8153 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
8154 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
8155 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
8156 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
8157 don't have real modifiers but
8158 should be treated similarly to
8159 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
8160 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
8161 || (XK_ISO_Lock <= orig_keysym
8162 && orig_keysym <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
8163 #endif
8164 ))
8165 {
8166 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
8167 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
8168 key. */
8169 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
8170 inev.ie.code = keysym;
8171 goto done_keysym;
8172 }
8173
8174 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
8175 ptrdiff_t i;
8176 int nchars, len;
8177
8178 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
8179 {
8180 if (ASCII_CHAR_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
8181 nchars++;
8182 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
8183 }
8184
8185 if (nchars < nbytes)
8186 {
8187 /* Decode the input data. */
8188
8189 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
8190 which depends on which X*LookupString function
8191 we used just above and the locale. */
8192 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
8193 coding.src_multibyte = false;
8194 coding.dst_multibyte = true;
8195 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
8196 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
8197 gives us composition information. */
8198 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
8199
8200 SAFE_NALLOCA (coding.destination, MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH,
8201 nbytes);
8202 coding.dst_bytes = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
8203 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
8204 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
8205 nbytes = coding.produced;
8206 nchars = coding.produced_char;
8207 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
8208 }
8209
8210 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
8211 character events. */
8212 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
8213 {
8214 int ch;
8215 if (nchars == nbytes)
8216 ch = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
8217 else
8218 ch = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
8219 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch)
8220 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
8221 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
8222 inev.ie.code = ch;
8223 kbd_buffer_store_buffered_event (&inev, hold_quit);
8224 }
8225
8226 count += nchars;
8227
8228 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
8229
8230 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
8231 break;
8232 }
8233 /* FIXME: check side effects and remove this. */
8234 ((XEvent *) event)->xkey = xkey;
8235 }
8236 done_keysym:
8237 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8238 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
8239 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
8240 client. */
8241 break;
8242 #else
8243 goto OTHER;
8244 #endif
8245
8246 case KeyRelease:
8247 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo, event->xkey.time);
8248 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8249 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
8250 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
8251 client. */
8252 break;
8253 #else
8254 goto OTHER;
8255 #endif
8256
8257 case EnterNotify:
8258 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo, event->xcrossing.time);
8259 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, any, event, &inev.ie);
8260
8261 f = any;
8262
8263 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
8264 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event->xmotion.time + 200;
8265
8266 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
8267 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
8268 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
8269 note_mouse_movement (f, &event->xmotion);
8270 #ifdef USE_GTK
8271 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
8272 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
8273 if (!f && dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph_frame)
8274 note_mouse_movement (dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event->xmotion);
8275 #endif
8276 goto OTHER;
8277
8278 case FocusIn:
8279 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, any, event, &inev.ie);
8280 goto OTHER;
8281
8282 case LeaveNotify:
8283 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo, event->xcrossing.time);
8284 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, any, event, &inev.ie);
8285
8286 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xcrossing.window);
8287 if (f)
8288 {
8289 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
8290 {
8291 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
8292 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
8293 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
8294 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
8295 }
8296
8297 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
8298 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
8299 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
8300 the mouse leaves the frame. */
8301 if (any_help_event_p)
8302 do_help = -1;
8303 }
8304 #ifdef USE_GTK
8305 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
8306 else if (dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph_frame)
8307 note_mouse_movement (dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event->xmotion);
8308 #endif
8309 goto OTHER;
8310
8311 case FocusOut:
8312 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, any, event, &inev.ie);
8313 goto OTHER;
8314
8315 case MotionNotify:
8316 {
8317 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo, event->xmotion.time);
8318 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
8319 help_echo_string = Qnil;
8320
8321 f = (x_mouse_grabbed (dpyinfo) ? dpyinfo->last_mouse_frame
8322 : x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xmotion.window));
8323
8324 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
8325 {
8326 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = false;
8327 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
8328 }
8329
8330 #ifdef USE_GTK
8331 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, event))
8332 f = 0;
8333 #endif
8334 if (f)
8335 {
8336
8337 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
8338 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
8339 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
8340 {
8341 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_window;
8342 Lisp_Object window = window_from_coordinates
8343 (f, event->xmotion.x, event->xmotion.y, 0, false);
8344
8345 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
8346 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
8347 will be selected only when it is active. */
8348 if (WINDOWP (window)
8349 && !EQ (window, last_mouse_window)
8350 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
8351 /* For click-to-focus window managers
8352 create event iff we don't leave the
8353 selected frame. */
8354 && (focus_follows_mouse
8355 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
8356 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
8357 {
8358 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
8359 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
8360 }
8361 /* Remember the last window where we saw the mouse. */
8362 last_mouse_window = window;
8363 }
8364 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event->xmotion))
8365 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
8366 }
8367 else
8368 {
8369 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
8370 struct scroll_bar *bar
8371 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event->xmotion.display,
8372 event->xmotion.window, 2);
8373
8374 if (bar)
8375 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event->xmotion);
8376 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
8377
8378 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
8379 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
8380 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
8381 }
8382
8383 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
8384 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
8385 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
8386 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
8387 do_help = 1;
8388 goto OTHER;
8389 }
8390
8391 case ConfigureNotify:
8392 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xconfigure.window);
8393 #ifdef USE_CAIRO
8394 if (f) x_cr_destroy_surface (f);
8395 #endif
8396 #ifdef USE_GTK
8397 if (!f
8398 && (f = any)
8399 && event->xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
8400 {
8401 xg_frame_resized (f, event->xconfigure.width,
8402 event->xconfigure.height);
8403 #ifdef USE_CAIRO
8404 x_cr_destroy_surface (f);
8405 #endif
8406 f = 0;
8407 }
8408 #endif
8409 if (f)
8410 {
8411 x_net_wm_state (f, event->xconfigure.window);
8412
8413 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8414 /* Tip frames are pure X window, set size for them. */
8415 if (! NILP (tip_frame) && XFRAME (tip_frame) == f)
8416 {
8417 if (FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) != event->xconfigure.height
8418 || FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) != event->xconfigure.width)
8419 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8420 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event->xconfigure.height;
8421 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event->xconfigure.width;
8422 }
8423 #endif
8424
8425 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8426 #ifndef USE_GTK
8427 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_TO_TEXT_WIDTH (f, event->xconfigure.width);
8428 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_TO_TEXT_HEIGHT (f, event->xconfigure.height);
8429
8430 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
8431 is called by the code that handles resizing
8432 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
8433
8434 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
8435 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
8436 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
8437 if (width != FRAME_TEXT_WIDTH (f)
8438 || height != FRAME_TEXT_HEIGHT (f)
8439 || event->xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
8440 || event->xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
8441 {
8442 change_frame_size (f, width, height, false, true, false, true);
8443 x_clear_under_internal_border (f);
8444 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8445 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8446 }
8447 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8448 #endif
8449
8450 #ifdef USE_GTK
8451 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
8452 Only get real positions when mapped. */
8453 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
8454 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
8455 #endif
8456 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
8457
8458 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8459 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
8460 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8461 #endif
8462
8463 }
8464 goto OTHER;
8465
8466 case ButtonRelease:
8467 case ButtonPress:
8468 {
8469 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
8470 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
8471 bool tool_bar_p = false;
8472
8473 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
8474 dpyinfo->last_mouse_glyph_frame = NULL;
8475 x_display_set_last_user_time (dpyinfo, event->xbutton.time);
8476
8477 f = (x_mouse_grabbed (dpyinfo) ? dpyinfo->last_mouse_frame
8478 : x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xbutton.window));
8479
8480 #ifdef USE_GTK
8481 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, event))
8482 f = 0;
8483 #endif
8484 if (f)
8485 {
8486 #if ! defined (USE_GTK)
8487 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
8488 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
8489 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
8490 {
8491 Lisp_Object window;
8492 int x = event->xbutton.x;
8493 int y = event->xbutton.y;
8494
8495 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, true);
8496 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
8497
8498 if (tool_bar_p && event->xbutton.button < 4)
8499 handle_tool_bar_click
8500 (f, x, y, event->xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
8501 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, event->xbutton.state));
8502 }
8503 #endif /* !USE_GTK */
8504
8505 if (!tool_bar_p)
8506 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
8507 if (! popup_activated ())
8508 #endif
8509 {
8510 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
8511 {
8512 if (event->type == ButtonPress
8513 && event->xbutton.time > ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
8514 {
8515 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
8516 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event->xbutton, f);
8517 }
8518 if (event->type == ButtonRelease)
8519 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
8520 }
8521 else
8522 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event->xbutton, f);
8523 }
8524 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
8525 xembed_send_message (f, event->xbutton.time,
8526 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
8527 }
8528 else
8529 {
8530 struct scroll_bar *bar
8531 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event->xbutton.display,
8532 event->xbutton.window, 2);
8533
8534 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
8535 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
8536 scroll bars. */
8537 if (bar && event->xbutton.state & ControlMask)
8538 {
8539 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, &inev.ie);
8540 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
8541 }
8542 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
8543 if (bar)
8544 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, &inev.ie);
8545 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
8546 }
8547
8548 if (event->type == ButtonPress)
8549 {
8550 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event->xbutton.button);
8551 dpyinfo->last_mouse_frame = f;
8552 #if ! defined (USE_GTK)
8553 if (f && !tool_bar_p)
8554 f->last_tool_bar_item = -1;
8555 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8556 }
8557 else
8558 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event->xbutton.button);
8559
8560 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
8561 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
8562 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
8563 if (f != 0)
8564 f->mouse_moved = false;
8565
8566 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
8567 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event);
8568 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
8569 don't pass it to Xt right now.
8570 Instead, save it away
8571 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
8572 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
8573 if (! popup_activated ()
8574 #ifdef USE_GTK
8575 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
8576 && event->xbutton.button < 3
8577 #endif
8578 && f && event->type == ButtonPress
8579 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
8580 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
8581 && event->xbutton.x >= 0
8582 && event->xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
8583 && event->xbutton.y >= 0
8584 && event->xbutton.y < FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f)
8585 && event->xbutton.same_screen)
8586 {
8587 if (!f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event)
8588 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = xmalloc (sizeof *event);
8589 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = *event;
8590 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT;
8591 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
8592 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
8593 }
8594 else
8595 goto OTHER;
8596 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
8597 }
8598 break;
8599
8600 case CirculateNotify:
8601 goto OTHER;
8602
8603 case CirculateRequest:
8604 goto OTHER;
8605
8606 case VisibilityNotify:
8607 goto OTHER;
8608
8609 case MappingNotify:
8610 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
8611 local cache. */
8612 switch (event->xmapping.request)
8613 {
8614 case MappingModifier:
8615 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
8616 /* This is meant to fall through. */
8617 case MappingKeyboard:
8618 XRefreshKeyboardMapping ((XMappingEvent *) &event->xmapping);
8619 }
8620 goto OTHER;
8621
8622 case DestroyNotify:
8623 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, event);
8624 break;
8625
8626 default:
8627 OTHER:
8628 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8629 block_input ();
8630 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
8631 XtDispatchEvent ((XEvent *) event);
8632 unblock_input ();
8633 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8634 break;
8635 }
8636
8637 done:
8638 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
8639 {
8640 kbd_buffer_store_buffered_event (&inev, hold_quit);
8641 count++;
8642 }
8643
8644 if (do_help
8645 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
8646 {
8647 Lisp_Object frame;
8648
8649 if (f)
8650 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8651 else
8652 frame = Qnil;
8653
8654 if (do_help > 0)
8655 {
8656 any_help_event_p = true;
8657 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
8658 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
8659 }
8660 else
8661 {
8662 help_echo_string = Qnil;
8663 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
8664 }
8665 count++;
8666 }
8667
8668 SAFE_FREE ();
8669 return count;
8670 }
8671
8672 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
8673 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
8674 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
8675
8676 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
8677 int
8678 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
8679 {
8680 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8681 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
8682
8683 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
8684
8685 if (dpyinfo)
8686 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
8687
8688 return finish;
8689 }
8690
8691 /* Read events coming from the X server.
8692 Return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
8693
8694 Return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
8695 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
8696 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
8697 C chars). */
8698
8699 static int
8700 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, struct input_event *hold_quit)
8701 {
8702 int count = 0;
8703 bool event_found = false;
8704 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
8705
8706 block_input ();
8707
8708 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
8709 if (dpyinfo == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
8710 {
8711 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
8712 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo->display);
8713 }
8714
8715 #ifndef USE_GTK
8716 while (XPending (dpyinfo->display))
8717 {
8718 int finish;
8719 XEvent event;
8720
8721 XNextEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
8722
8723 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8724 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
8725 if (x_filter_event (dpyinfo, &event))
8726 continue;
8727 #endif
8728 event_found = true;
8729
8730 count += handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, &event, &finish, hold_quit);
8731
8732 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
8733 break;
8734 }
8735
8736 #else /* USE_GTK */
8737
8738 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
8739 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
8740 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
8741 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
8742
8743 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
8744 from all displays. */
8745
8746 while (gtk_events_pending ())
8747 {
8748 current_count = count;
8749 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
8750
8751 gtk_main_iteration ();
8752
8753 count = current_count;
8754 current_count = -1;
8755 current_hold_quit = 0;
8756
8757 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
8758 break;
8759 }
8760 #endif /* USE_GTK */
8761
8762 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
8763 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
8764 if (! event_found)
8765 {
8766 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
8767 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
8768 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
8769 x_noop_count++;
8770 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
8771 {
8772 x_noop_count=0;
8773
8774 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
8775 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
8776
8777 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
8778
8779 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
8780 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
8781 }
8782 }
8783
8784 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
8785 raise it now. FIXME: handle more than one such frame. */
8786 if (dpyinfo->x_pending_autoraise_frame)
8787 {
8788 x_raise_frame (dpyinfo->x_pending_autoraise_frame);
8789 dpyinfo->x_pending_autoraise_frame = NULL;
8790 }
8791
8792 unblock_input ();
8793
8794 return count;
8795 }
8796
8797
8798
8799 \f
8800 /***********************************************************************
8801 Text Cursor
8802 ***********************************************************************/
8803
8804 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
8805 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
8806
8807 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
8808 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
8809 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
8810
8811 static void
8812 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row,
8813 enum glyph_row_area area, GC gc)
8814 {
8815 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
8816 XRectangle clip_rect;
8817 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
8818
8819 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
8820
8821 clip_rect.x = window_x;
8822 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
8823 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
8824 clip_rect.width = window_width;
8825 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
8826
8827 x_set_clip_rectangles (f, gc, &clip_rect, 1);
8828 }
8829
8830
8831 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
8832
8833 static void
8834 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
8835 {
8836 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
8837 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8838 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8839 int x, y, wd, h;
8840 XGCValues xgcv;
8841 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
8842 GC gc;
8843
8844 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
8845 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
8846 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
8847 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
8848 return;
8849
8850 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
8851 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
8852 wd = w->phys_cursor_width - 1;
8853
8854 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
8855 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
8856 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
8857 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
8858 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
8859 else
8860 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8861 GCForeground, &xgcv);
8862 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
8863
8864 /* When on R2L character, show cursor at the right edge of the
8865 glyph, unless the cursor box is as wide as the glyph or wider
8866 (the latter happens when x-stretch-cursor is non-nil). */
8867 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0
8868 && cursor_glyph->pixel_width > wd)
8869 {
8870 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - wd;
8871 if (wd > 0)
8872 wd -= 1;
8873 }
8874 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
8875 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
8876 x_draw_rectangle (f, gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
8877 x_reset_clip_rectangles (f, gc);
8878 }
8879
8880
8881 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
8882
8883 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
8884 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
8885 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
8886 --gerd. */
8887
8888 static void
8889 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
8890 {
8891 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
8892 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
8893
8894 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
8895 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
8896 and mini-buffer. */
8897 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
8898 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
8899 return;
8900
8901 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
8902 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
8903 the bar might not be in the window. */
8904 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
8905 {
8906 struct glyph_row *r;
8907 r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
8908 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, r, DRAW_CURSOR);
8909 }
8910 else
8911 {
8912 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8913 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
8914 GC gc = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
8915 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
8916 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
8917 XGCValues xgcv;
8918
8919 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
8920 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
8921 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
8922 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
8923 that the glyph is legible. */
8924 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
8925 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
8926 else
8927 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
8928 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
8929
8930 if (gc)
8931 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
8932 else
8933 {
8934 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
8935 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
8936 }
8937
8938 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
8939
8940 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
8941 {
8942 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
8943
8944 if (width < 0)
8945 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
8946 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
8947
8948 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
8949
8950 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
8951 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
8952 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
8953 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
8954
8955 x_fill_rectangle (f, gc, x,
8956 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
8957 width, row->height);
8958 }
8959 else /* HBAR_CURSOR */
8960 {
8961 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
8962 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
8963
8964 if (width < 0)
8965 width = row->height;
8966
8967 width = min (row->height, width);
8968
8969 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
8970 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
8971
8972 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0
8973 && cursor_glyph->pixel_width > w->phys_cursor_width - 1)
8974 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - w->phys_cursor_width + 1;
8975 x_fill_rectangle (f, gc, x,
8976 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
8977 row->height - width),
8978 w->phys_cursor_width - 1, width);
8979 }
8980
8981 x_reset_clip_rectangles (f, gc);
8982 }
8983 }
8984
8985
8986 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
8987
8988 static void
8989 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
8990 {
8991 if (!f->pointer_invisible
8992 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
8993 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
8994 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
8995 }
8996
8997
8998 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
8999
9000 static void
9001 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
9002 {
9003 x_clear_area (f, x, y, width, height);
9004 #ifdef USE_GTK
9005 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
9006 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
9007 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
9008 #endif
9009 }
9010
9011
9012 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
9013
9014 static void
9015 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x,
9016 int y, enum text_cursor_kinds cursor_type,
9017 int cursor_width, bool on_p, bool active_p)
9018 {
9019 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
9020
9021 if (on_p)
9022 {
9023 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
9024 w->phys_cursor_on_p = true;
9025
9026 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
9027 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
9028 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
9029 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
9030 {
9031 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = true;
9032 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
9033 }
9034 else
9035 {
9036 switch (cursor_type)
9037 {
9038 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
9039 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
9040 break;
9041
9042 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
9043 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
9044 break;
9045
9046 case BAR_CURSOR:
9047 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
9048 break;
9049
9050 case HBAR_CURSOR:
9051 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
9052 break;
9053
9054 case NO_CURSOR:
9055 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
9056 break;
9057
9058 default:
9059 emacs_abort ();
9060 }
9061 }
9062
9063 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9064 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
9065 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
9066 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
9067 #endif
9068 }
9069
9070 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9071 }
9072
9073 \f
9074 /* Icons. */
9075
9076 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
9077
9078 bool
9079 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
9080 {
9081 ptrdiff_t bitmap_id;
9082
9083 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
9084 return true;
9085
9086 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
9087 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
9088 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
9089 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
9090
9091 if (STRINGP (file))
9092 {
9093 #ifdef USE_GTK
9094 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
9095 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
9096 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
9097 return false;
9098 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9099 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
9100 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
9101 }
9102 else
9103 {
9104 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
9105 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
9106 {
9107 ptrdiff_t rc = -1;
9108
9109 #ifdef USE_GTK
9110
9111 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
9112 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
9113 {
9114 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = -2;
9115 return false;
9116 }
9117
9118 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
9119
9120 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
9121 if (rc != -1)
9122 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
9123
9124 #endif
9125
9126 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
9127 if (rc == -1)
9128 {
9129 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits,
9130 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
9131 if (rc == -1)
9132 return true;
9133
9134 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
9135 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
9136 }
9137 }
9138
9139 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
9140 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
9141 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
9142 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
9143 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
9144
9145 bitmap_id = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
9146 }
9147
9148 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
9149 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
9150
9151 return false;
9152 }
9153
9154
9155 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
9156 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
9157
9158 bool
9159 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
9160 {
9161 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
9162 return true;
9163
9164 {
9165 XTextProperty text;
9166 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
9167 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
9168 text.format = 8;
9169 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
9170 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
9171 }
9172
9173 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
9174 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
9175 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
9176 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
9177
9178 return false;
9179 }
9180 \f
9181 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
9182
9183 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
9184 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
9185
9186 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
9187 be called from a signal handler.
9188 */
9189
9190 struct x_error_message_stack {
9191 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
9192 Display *dpy;
9193 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
9194 };
9195 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
9196
9197 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
9198 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
9199 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
9200
9201 static void
9202 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
9203 {
9204 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code,
9205 x_error_message->string,
9206 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
9207 }
9208
9209 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
9210 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
9211 operating on.
9212
9213 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
9214 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
9215 stored in *x_error_message.
9216
9217 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
9218 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
9219
9220 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
9221
9222 void
9223 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
9224 {
9225 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof *data);
9226
9227 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
9228 XSync (dpy, False);
9229
9230 data->dpy = dpy;
9231 data->string[0] = 0;
9232 data->prev = x_error_message;
9233 x_error_message = data;
9234 }
9235
9236 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
9237 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
9238
9239 void
9240 x_uncatch_errors (void)
9241 {
9242 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
9243
9244 block_input ();
9245
9246 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
9247 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
9248 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
9249 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
9250
9251 tmp = x_error_message;
9252 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
9253 xfree (tmp);
9254 unblock_input ();
9255 }
9256
9257 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
9258 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
9259 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
9260
9261 void
9262 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
9263 {
9264 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
9265 XSync (dpy, False);
9266
9267 if (x_error_message->string[0])
9268 {
9269 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
9270 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
9271 x_uncatch_errors ();
9272 error (format, string);
9273 }
9274 }
9275
9276 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
9277 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
9278
9279 bool
9280 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
9281 {
9282 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
9283 XSync (dpy, False);
9284
9285 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
9286 }
9287
9288 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
9289
9290 void
9291 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
9292 {
9293 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
9294 }
9295
9296 #if false
9297 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
9298 * idea. --lorentey */
9299 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
9300
9301 void
9302 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
9303 {
9304 while (x_error_message)
9305 x_uncatch_errors ();
9306 }
9307 #endif
9308
9309 #if false
9310 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
9311 x_trace_wire (void)
9312 {
9313 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
9314 }
9315 #endif
9316
9317 \f
9318 /************************************************************************
9319 Handling X errors
9320 ************************************************************************/
9321
9322 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
9323
9324 static char *error_msg;
9325
9326 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
9327 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
9328
9329 static void
9330 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message, bool ioerror)
9331 {
9332 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
9333 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
9334 ptrdiff_t idx = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
9335
9336 error_msg = alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
9337 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
9338
9339 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
9340 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
9341
9342 if (dpyinfo)
9343 {
9344 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
9345 frame on it. */
9346 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
9347 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
9348 }
9349 if (ioerror) dpyinfo->display = 0;
9350
9351 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
9352 that are on the dead display. */
9353 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
9354 {
9355 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
9356 minibuf_frame
9357 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
9358 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
9359 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
9360 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
9361 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
9362 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
9363 }
9364
9365 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
9366 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
9367 for another frame that we need to delete. */
9368 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
9369 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
9370 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
9371 {
9372 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
9373 trying to find a replacement. */
9374 kset_default_minibuffer_frame (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame)), Qt);
9375 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
9376 }
9377
9378 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
9379 first place, so don't try to close it. */
9380 if (dpyinfo)
9381 {
9382 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
9383 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
9384 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
9385 #ifdef USE_GTK
9386 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
9387 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
9388 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
9389 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
9390 shut_down_emacs (0, Qnil);
9391 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
9392 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
9393 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
9394 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
9395 error_msg);
9396 emacs_abort ();
9397 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9398
9399 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
9400 dpyinfo->display = 0;
9401
9402 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9403 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
9404 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
9405 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
9406 emacs_abort ();
9407
9408 {
9409 Lisp_Object tmp;
9410 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
9411 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
9412 }
9413 }
9414
9415 if (terminal_list == 0)
9416 {
9417 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
9418 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
9419 /* NOTREACHED */
9420 }
9421
9422 totally_unblock_input ();
9423
9424 unbind_to (idx, Qnil);
9425 clear_waiting_for_input ();
9426
9427 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
9428 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list) return; )
9429
9430 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
9431 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
9432 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
9433 error ("%s", error_msg);
9434 }
9435
9436 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
9437 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
9438 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
9439
9440 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
9441 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
9442
9443 static int
9444 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
9445 {
9446 #if defined USE_GTK && defined HAVE_GTK3
9447 if ((event->error_code == BadMatch || event->error_code == BadWindow)
9448 && event->request_code == X_SetInputFocus)
9449 {
9450 return 0;
9451 }
9452 #endif
9453
9454 if (x_error_message)
9455 x_error_catcher (display, event);
9456 else
9457 x_error_quitter (display, event);
9458 return 0;
9459 }
9460
9461 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
9462 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
9463 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
9464
9465 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
9466
9467 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
9468 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
9469
9470 static void NO_INLINE
9471 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
9472 {
9473 char buf[256], buf1[356];
9474
9475 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
9476 or colors that are not defined. */
9477
9478 if (event->error_code == BadName)
9479 return;
9480
9481 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
9482 original error handler. */
9483
9484 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
9485 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
9486 buf, event->request_code);
9487 x_connection_closed (display, buf1, false);
9488 }
9489
9490
9491 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
9492 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
9493 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
9494
9495 static int
9496 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
9497 {
9498 char buf[256];
9499
9500 snprintf (buf, sizeof buf, "Connection lost to X server '%s'",
9501 DisplayString (display));
9502 x_connection_closed (display, buf, true);
9503 return 0;
9504 }
9505 \f
9506 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
9507
9508 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
9509 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
9510 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
9511 FONT-OBJECT. */
9512
9513 Lisp_Object
9514 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
9515 {
9516 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
9517 int unit, font_ascent, font_descent;
9518
9519 if (fontset < 0)
9520 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
9521 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
9522 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
9523 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
9524 do. */
9525 return font_object;
9526
9527 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
9528 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
9529 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
9530 get_font_ascent_descent (font, &font_ascent, &font_descent);
9531 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = font_ascent + font_descent;
9532
9533 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9534 FRAME_MENU_BAR_HEIGHT (f) = FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9535 #endif
9536
9537 /* Compute character columns occupied by scrollbar.
9538
9539 Don't do things differently for non-toolkit scrollbars
9540 (Bug#17163). */
9541 unit = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9542 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
9543 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
9544 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + unit - 1) / unit;
9545 else
9546 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + unit - 1) / unit;
9547
9548 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
9549 {
9550 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
9551 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
9552 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
9553 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
9554 adjust_frame_size (f, FRAME_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f),
9555 FRAME_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f), 3,
9556 false, Qfont);
9557 }
9558
9559 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9560 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
9561 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
9562 {
9563 block_input ();
9564 xic_set_xfontset (f, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
9565 unblock_input ();
9566 }
9567 #endif
9568
9569 return font_object;
9570 }
9571
9572 \f
9573 /***********************************************************************
9574 X Input Methods
9575 ***********************************************************************/
9576
9577 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9578
9579 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
9580
9581 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
9582 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
9583 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
9584
9585 static void
9586 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
9587 {
9588 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
9589 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
9590
9591 block_input ();
9592
9593 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
9594 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
9595 {
9596 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
9597 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
9598 {
9599 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
9600 xic_free_xfontset (f);
9601 }
9602 }
9603
9604 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
9605 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
9606 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
9607 unblock_input ();
9608 }
9609
9610 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
9611
9612 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
9613 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
9614
9615 static void
9616 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
9617 {
9618 XIM xim;
9619
9620 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
9621 if (use_xim)
9622 {
9623 if (dpyinfo->xim)
9624 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
9625 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
9626 emacs_class);
9627 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
9628
9629 if (xim)
9630 {
9631 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
9632 XIMCallback destroy;
9633 #endif
9634
9635 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
9636 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
9637
9638 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
9639 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
9640 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
9641 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
9642 #endif
9643 }
9644 }
9645
9646 else
9647 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
9648 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
9649 }
9650
9651
9652 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
9653
9654 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
9655 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
9656 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
9657 when the callback was registered. */
9658
9659 static void
9660 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
9661 {
9662 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
9663 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
9664
9665 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
9666 if (dpyinfo->xim)
9667 return;
9668
9669 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
9670
9671 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
9672 as they have no XIC. */
9673 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
9674 {
9675 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
9676
9677 block_input ();
9678 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
9679 {
9680 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
9681
9682 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
9683 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
9684 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
9685 {
9686 create_frame_xic (f);
9687 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
9688 xic_set_statusarea (f);
9689 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
9690 {
9691 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
9692 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
9693 }
9694 }
9695 }
9696
9697 unblock_input ();
9698 }
9699 }
9700
9701 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
9702
9703
9704 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
9705 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
9706 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
9707 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
9708
9709 static void
9710 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
9711 {
9712 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
9713 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
9714 if (use_xim)
9715 {
9716 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
9717 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = xmalloc (sizeof *xim_inst);
9718 Bool ret;
9719
9720 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
9721 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
9722 xim_inst->resource_name = xstrdup (resource_name);
9723 ret = XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback
9724 (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, xim_inst->resource_name,
9725 emacs_class, xim_instantiate_callback,
9726 /* This is XPointer in XFree86 but (XPointer *)
9727 on Tru64, at least, hence the configure test. */
9728 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
9729 eassert (ret == True);
9730 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
9731 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
9732 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
9733 }
9734 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
9735 }
9736
9737
9738 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
9739
9740 static void
9741 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
9742 {
9743 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
9744 if (use_xim)
9745 {
9746 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
9747 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = dpyinfo->xim_callback_data;
9748
9749 if (dpyinfo->display)
9750 {
9751 Bool ret = XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback
9752 (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, xim_inst->resource_name,
9753 emacs_class, xim_instantiate_callback,
9754 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
9755 eassert (ret == True);
9756 }
9757 xfree (xim_inst->resource_name);
9758 xfree (xim_inst);
9759 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
9760 if (dpyinfo->display)
9761 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
9762 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
9763 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
9764 }
9765 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
9766 }
9767
9768 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
9769
9770
9771 \f
9772 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
9773 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
9774
9775 static void
9776 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
9777 {
9778 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
9779
9780 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
9781 is already for the top-left corner. */
9782 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
9783 return;
9784
9785 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
9786 position that fits on the screen. */
9787 if (flags & XNegative)
9788 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9789 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
9790
9791 {
9792 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9793
9794 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
9795 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
9796 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
9797
9798 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
9799 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
9800 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
9801 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
9802 is right, though.
9803
9804 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
9805 2000-12-01, gerd. */
9806
9807 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
9808 #endif
9809
9810 if (flags & YNegative)
9811 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9812 - height + f->top_pos;
9813 }
9814
9815 /* The left_pos and top_pos
9816 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
9817 so the flags should correspond. */
9818 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
9819 }
9820
9821 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
9822 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
9823 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
9824 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
9825 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
9826
9827 void
9828 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
9829 {
9830 int modified_top, modified_left;
9831
9832 if (change_gravity > 0)
9833 {
9834 f->top_pos = yoff;
9835 f->left_pos = xoff;
9836 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
9837 if (xoff < 0)
9838 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
9839 if (yoff < 0)
9840 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
9841 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
9842 }
9843 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
9844
9845 block_input ();
9846 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, 0, false);
9847
9848 modified_left = f->left_pos;
9849 modified_top = f->top_pos;
9850
9851 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
9852 {
9853 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
9854 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
9855 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
9856 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
9857 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
9858 }
9859
9860 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9861 modified_left, modified_top);
9862
9863 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
9864 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN);
9865
9866 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
9867 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
9868 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
9869 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
9870 of the frame.
9871
9872 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
9873 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
9874 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
9875
9876 if (change_gravity != 0
9877 && (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
9878 || (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
9879 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
9880 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
9881 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
9882
9883 unblock_input ();
9884 }
9885
9886 /* Return true if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
9887 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
9888 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
9889 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
9890 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
9891
9892 bool
9893 x_wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
9894 {
9895 Atom actual_type;
9896 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
9897 int i, rc, actual_format;
9898 bool ret;
9899 Window wmcheck_window;
9900 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9901 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
9902 int max_len = 65536;
9903 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
9904 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
9905 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
9906
9907 block_input ();
9908
9909 x_catch_errors (dpy);
9910 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
9911 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
9912 0, max_len, False, target_type,
9913 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
9914 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
9915
9916 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9917 {
9918 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
9919 x_uncatch_errors ();
9920 unblock_input ();
9921 return false;
9922 }
9923
9924 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
9925 XFree (tmp_data);
9926
9927 /* Check if window exists. */
9928 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
9929 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9930 {
9931 x_uncatch_errors ();
9932 unblock_input ();
9933 return false;
9934 }
9935
9936 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
9937 {
9938 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
9939 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
9940 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
9941 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
9942 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
9943 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
9944
9945 target_type = XA_ATOM;
9946 tmp_data = NULL;
9947 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
9948 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
9949 0, max_len, False, target_type,
9950 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
9951 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
9952
9953 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9954 {
9955 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
9956 x_uncatch_errors ();
9957 unblock_input ();
9958 return false;
9959 }
9960
9961 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
9962 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
9963 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
9964 }
9965
9966 ret = false;
9967
9968 for (i = 0; !ret && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
9969 ret = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
9970
9971 x_uncatch_errors ();
9972 unblock_input ();
9973
9974 return ret;
9975 }
9976
9977 static void
9978 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, bool add, Atom atom, Atom value)
9979 {
9980 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
9981
9982 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
9983 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
9984 make_number (32),
9985 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
9986 Fcons
9987 (make_number (add),
9988 Fcons
9989 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
9990 (value != 0
9991 ? list1 (make_fixnum_or_float (value))
9992 : Qnil))));
9993 }
9994
9995 void
9996 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
9997 {
9998 Lisp_Object frame;
9999 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10000
10001 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
10002
10003 set_wm_state (frame, !NILP (new_value),
10004 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
10005 }
10006
10007 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
10008 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
10009 Set *STICKY to the sticky state.
10010
10011 Return true iff we are not hidden. */
10012
10013 static bool
10014 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
10015 Window window,
10016 int *size_state,
10017 bool *sticky)
10018 {
10019 Atom actual_type;
10020 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
10021 int i, rc, actual_format;
10022 bool is_hidden = false;
10023 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10024 long max_len = 65536;
10025 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
10026 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
10027 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
10028
10029 *sticky = false;
10030 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
10031
10032 block_input ();
10033 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10034 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
10035 0, max_len, False, target_type,
10036 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
10037 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
10038
10039 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
10040 {
10041 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
10042 x_uncatch_errors ();
10043 unblock_input ();
10044 return !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f);
10045 }
10046
10047 x_uncatch_errors ();
10048
10049 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
10050 {
10051 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
10052 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden)
10053 is_hidden = true;
10054 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
10055 {
10056 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
10057 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
10058 else
10059 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
10060 }
10061 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
10062 {
10063 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
10064 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
10065 else
10066 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
10067 }
10068 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
10069 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
10070 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
10071 *sticky = true;
10072 }
10073
10074 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
10075 unblock_input ();
10076 return ! is_hidden;
10077 }
10078
10079 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
10080
10081 static bool
10082 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
10083 {
10084 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10085 bool have_net_atom = x_wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
10086 int cur;
10087 bool dummy;
10088
10089 get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
10090
10091 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
10092 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
10093 if (!have_net_atom)
10094 have_net_atom = x_wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
10095
10096 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
10097 {
10098 Lisp_Object frame;
10099
10100 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
10101
10102 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
10103 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
10104 are sent at once. */
10105 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
10106 {
10107 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
10108 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
10109 set_wm_state (frame, true, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
10110 None);
10111 break;
10112 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
10113 if (x_frame_normalize_before_maximize && cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
10114 {
10115 set_wm_state (frame, false,
10116 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
10117 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
10118 set_wm_state (frame, true,
10119 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
10120 }
10121 else
10122 {
10123 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
10124 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
10125 set_wm_state (frame, false, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
10126 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
10127 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED || x_frame_normalize_before_maximize)
10128 set_wm_state (frame, true,
10129 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
10130 }
10131 break;
10132 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
10133 if (x_frame_normalize_before_maximize && cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
10134 {
10135 set_wm_state (frame, false,
10136 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
10137 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
10138 set_wm_state (frame, true,
10139 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
10140 }
10141 else
10142 {
10143 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
10144 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
10145 set_wm_state (frame, false, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
10146 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
10147 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED || x_frame_normalize_before_maximize)
10148 set_wm_state (frame, true,
10149 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
10150 }
10151 break;
10152 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
10153 if (x_frame_normalize_before_maximize && cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
10154 {
10155 set_wm_state (frame, false,
10156 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
10157 set_wm_state (frame, true,
10158 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
10159 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
10160 }
10161 else if (x_frame_normalize_before_maximize && cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
10162 {
10163 set_wm_state (frame, false,
10164 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
10165 set_wm_state (frame, true,
10166 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
10167 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
10168 }
10169 else if (x_frame_normalize_before_maximize && cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
10170 {
10171 set_wm_state (frame, false,
10172 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
10173 set_wm_state (frame, true,
10174 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
10175 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
10176 }
10177 else
10178 {
10179 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
10180 set_wm_state (frame, false, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
10181 None);
10182 else if (cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
10183 set_wm_state (frame, true,
10184 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
10185 else if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
10186 set_wm_state (frame, true, None,
10187 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
10188 else
10189 set_wm_state (frame, true,
10190 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
10191 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
10192 }
10193 break;
10194 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
10195 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
10196 set_wm_state (frame, false, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
10197 None);
10198 else
10199 set_wm_state (frame, false,
10200 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
10201 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
10202 }
10203
10204 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
10205
10206 }
10207
10208 return have_net_atom;
10209 }
10210
10211 static void
10212 XTfullscreen_hook (struct frame *f)
10213 {
10214 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
10215 {
10216 block_input ();
10217 x_check_fullscreen (f);
10218 x_sync (f);
10219 unblock_input ();
10220 }
10221 }
10222
10223
10224 static bool
10225 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, const XPropertyEvent *event)
10226 {
10227 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
10228 Lisp_Object lval;
10229 bool sticky = false;
10230 bool not_hidden = get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
10231
10232 lval = Qnil;
10233 switch (value)
10234 {
10235 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
10236 lval = Qfullwidth;
10237 break;
10238 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
10239 lval = Qfullheight;
10240 break;
10241 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
10242 lval = Qfullboth;
10243 break;
10244 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
10245 lval = Qmaximized;
10246 break;
10247 }
10248
10249 frame_size_history_add
10250 (f, Qx_handle_net_wm_state, 0, 0,
10251 list2 (get_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen), lval));
10252
10253 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
10254 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
10255
10256 return not_hidden;
10257 }
10258
10259 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
10260 If so needed, resize the frame. */
10261 static void
10262 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
10263 {
10264 Lisp_Object lval = Qnil;
10265
10266 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
10267 return;
10268
10269 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
10270 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
10271
10272 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
10273 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
10274 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
10275
10276 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
10277 {
10278 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
10279 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10280
10281 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
10282 {
10283 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
10284 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
10285 lval = Qmaximized;
10286 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
10287 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
10288 break;
10289 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
10290 lval = Qfullboth;
10291 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
10292 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
10293 break;
10294 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
10295 lval = Qfullwidth;
10296 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
10297 height = height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
10298 break;
10299 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
10300 lval = Qfullheight;
10301 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
10302 break;
10303 default:
10304 emacs_abort ();
10305 }
10306
10307 frame_size_history_add
10308 (f, Qx_check_fullscreen, width, height, Qnil);
10309
10310 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, 0, false);
10311
10312 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
10313 width, height);
10314
10315 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
10316 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
10317 else
10318 {
10319 change_frame_size (f, width, height - FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f),
10320 false, true, false, true);
10321 x_sync (f);
10322 }
10323 }
10324
10325 /* `x_net_wm_state' might have reset the fullscreen frame parameter,
10326 restore it. */
10327 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
10328 }
10329
10330 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
10331 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
10332 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
10333 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
10334 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
10335 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
10336 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
10337
10338 static void
10339 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
10340 {
10341 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
10342
10343 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
10344 window manager window around the frame. */
10345
10346 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
10347
10348 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
10349 {
10350 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
10351
10352 int adjusted_left;
10353 int adjusted_top;
10354
10355 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
10356 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
10357 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
10358
10359 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
10360
10361 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
10362 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
10363
10364 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
10365 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
10366
10367 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, false);
10368 }
10369 else
10370 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
10371 frame's position. */
10372
10373 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
10374 }
10375
10376
10377 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
10378 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
10379 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
10380 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
10381 of an exact comparison. */
10382
10383 static void
10384 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, bool fuzzy)
10385 {
10386 int count = 0;
10387
10388 while (count++ < 50)
10389 {
10390 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
10391
10392 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
10393 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
10394 loop. */
10395
10396 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
10397 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
10398
10399 if (fuzzy)
10400 {
10401 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
10402 pixels. */
10403
10404 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
10405 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
10406 return;
10407 }
10408 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
10409 return;
10410 }
10411
10412 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
10413 will then return up-to-date position info. */
10414
10415 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000000, 0, false, Qnil, NULL, 0);
10416 }
10417
10418
10419 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
10420 void
10421 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
10422 {
10423 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
10424
10425 fd_set fds;
10426 struct timespec tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
10427 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
10428
10429 f->wait_event_type = eventtype;
10430
10431 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticeable.
10432 Maybe it should be configurable. */
10433 tmo = make_timespec (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
10434 tmo_at = timespec_add (current_timespec (), tmo);
10435
10436 while (f->wait_event_type)
10437 {
10438 pending_signals = true;
10439 totally_unblock_input ();
10440 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
10441 block_input ();
10442 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
10443
10444 FD_ZERO (&fds);
10445 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
10446
10447 time_now = current_timespec ();
10448 if (timespec_cmp (tmo_at, time_now) < 0)
10449 break;
10450
10451 tmo = timespec_sub (tmo_at, time_now);
10452 if (pselect (fd + 1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo, NULL) == 0)
10453 break; /* Timeout */
10454 }
10455
10456 f->wait_event_type = 0;
10457 }
10458
10459
10460 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to WIDTH/HEIGHT in the case F
10461 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY, change to
10462 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
10463 size changes. Otherwise leave the window gravity unchanged. */
10464
10465 static void
10466 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, bool change_gravity,
10467 int width, int height)
10468 {
10469 int pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, width);
10470 int pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, height);
10471 int old_width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
10472 int old_height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
10473 Lisp_Object fullscreen = get_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen);
10474
10475 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
10476 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, 0, false);
10477
10478 /* When the frame is fullheight and we only want to change the width
10479 or it is fullwidth and we only want to change the height we should
10480 be able to preserve the fullscreen property. However, due to the
10481 fact that we have to send a resize request anyway, the window
10482 manager will abolish it. At least the respective size should
10483 remain unchanged but giving the frame back its normal size will
10484 be broken ... */
10485 if (EQ (fullscreen, Qfullwidth) && width == FRAME_TEXT_WIDTH (f))
10486 {
10487 frame_size_history_add
10488 (f, Qxg_frame_set_char_size_1, width, height,
10489 list2 (make_number (old_height),
10490 make_number (pixelheight + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f))));
10491
10492 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
10493 old_width, pixelheight + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f));
10494 }
10495 else if (EQ (fullscreen, Qfullheight) && height == FRAME_TEXT_HEIGHT (f))
10496 {
10497 frame_size_history_add
10498 (f, Qxg_frame_set_char_size_2, width, height,
10499 list2 (make_number (old_width), make_number (pixelwidth)));
10500
10501 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
10502 pixelwidth, old_height);
10503 }
10504
10505 else
10506 {
10507 frame_size_history_add
10508 (f, Qxg_frame_set_char_size_3, width, height,
10509 list2 (make_number (pixelwidth + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f)),
10510 make_number (pixelheight + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f)
10511 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f))));
10512
10513 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
10514 pixelwidth, pixelheight + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f));
10515 fullscreen = Qnil;
10516 }
10517
10518
10519
10520 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
10521 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
10522 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
10523 we have to make sure to do it here. */
10524 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
10525
10526 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
10527 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
10528 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
10529 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
10530
10531 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
10532 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
10533 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
10534 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
10535 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
10536
10537 Pass true for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
10538 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
10539
10540 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
10541 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
10542 for the ConfigureNotify. */
10543 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
10544 {
10545 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
10546
10547 if (!NILP (fullscreen))
10548 /* Try to restore fullscreen state. */
10549 {
10550 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, fullscreen);
10551 x_set_fullscreen (f, fullscreen, fullscreen);
10552 }
10553 }
10554 else
10555 {
10556 change_frame_size (f, width, height, false, true, false, true);
10557 x_sync (f);
10558 }
10559 }
10560
10561
10562 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
10563 If CHANGE_GRAVITY, change to top-left-corner window gravity
10564 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
10565 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
10566
10567 void
10568 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, bool change_gravity,
10569 int width, int height, bool pixelwise)
10570 {
10571 block_input ();
10572
10573 /* The following breaks our calculations. If it's really needed,
10574 think of something else. */
10575 #if false
10576 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
10577 {
10578 int text_width, text_height;
10579
10580 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
10581 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
10582 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/width to
10583 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
10584 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
10585 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
10586 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
10587 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
10588 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10589 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
10590 is however. */
10591 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
10592 #endif
10593 text_width = FRAME_PIXEL_TO_TEXT_WIDTH (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
10594 text_height = FRAME_PIXEL_TO_TEXT_HEIGHT (f, pixelh);
10595
10596 change_frame_size (f, text_width, text_height, false, true, false, true);
10597 }
10598 #endif
10599
10600 /* Pixelize width and height, if necessary. */
10601 if (! pixelwise)
10602 {
10603 width = width * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
10604 height = height * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
10605 }
10606
10607 #ifdef USE_GTK
10608 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
10609 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, width, height);
10610 else
10611 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, width, height);
10612 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10613 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, width, height);
10614 x_clear_under_internal_border (f);
10615 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
10616
10617 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
10618 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
10619
10620 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
10621 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
10622 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
10623 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
10624 cancel_mouse_face (f);
10625
10626 unblock_input ();
10627 }
10628
10629 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
10630
10631 void
10632 frame_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
10633 {
10634 block_input ();
10635
10636 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
10637 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
10638 unblock_input ();
10639 }
10640 \f
10641 /* Raise frame F. */
10642
10643 void
10644 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
10645 {
10646 block_input ();
10647 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
10648 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
10649 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
10650 unblock_input ();
10651 }
10652
10653 /* Lower frame F. */
10654
10655 static void
10656 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
10657 {
10658 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
10659 {
10660 block_input ();
10661 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
10662 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
10663 unblock_input ();
10664 }
10665 }
10666
10667 /* Request focus with XEmbed */
10668
10669 void
10670 xembed_request_focus (struct frame *f)
10671 {
10672 /* See XEmbed Protocol Specification at
10673 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/xembed-spec */
10674 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
10675 xembed_send_message (f, CurrentTime,
10676 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
10677 }
10678
10679 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
10680
10681 void
10682 x_ewmh_activate_frame (struct frame *f)
10683 {
10684 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
10685 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
10686
10687 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10688
10689 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && x_wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
10690 {
10691 Lisp_Object frame;
10692 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
10693 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
10694 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
10695 make_number (32),
10696 list2i (1, dpyinfo->last_user_time));
10697 }
10698 }
10699
10700 static void
10701 XTframe_raise_lower (struct frame *f, bool raise_flag)
10702 {
10703 if (raise_flag)
10704 x_raise_frame (f);
10705 else
10706 x_lower_frame (f);
10707 }
10708 \f
10709 /* XEmbed implementation. */
10710
10711 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
10712
10713 /* XEmbed implementation. */
10714
10715 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
10716
10717 static void
10718 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
10719 {
10720 unsigned long data[2];
10721 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
10722
10723 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
10724 data[1] = flags;
10725
10726 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
10727 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
10728 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
10729 }
10730 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
10731
10732 static void
10733 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time t, enum xembed_message msg,
10734 long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
10735 {
10736 XEvent event;
10737
10738 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
10739 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
10740 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
10741 event.xclient.format = 32;
10742 event.xclient.data.l[0] = t;
10743 event.xclient.data.l[1] = msg;
10744 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
10745 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
10746 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
10747
10748 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
10749 False, NoEventMask, &event);
10750 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
10751 }
10752 \f
10753 /* Change of visibility. */
10754
10755 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
10756 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
10757 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
10758 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
10759 but it will become visible later when the window manager
10760 finishes with it. */
10761
10762 void
10763 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
10764 {
10765 int original_top, original_left;
10766 int tries = 0;
10767
10768 block_input ();
10769
10770 x_set_bitmap_icon (f);
10771
10772 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
10773 {
10774 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
10775 call x_set_offset a second time
10776 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
10777 before the window gets really visible. */
10778 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
10779 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
10780 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
10781 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
10782
10783 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = true;
10784
10785 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
10786 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
10787 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10788 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
10789 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
10790 else
10791 {
10792 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
10793 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
10794 }
10795 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10796 #ifdef USE_GTK
10797 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
10798 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
10799 #else
10800 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
10801 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
10802 else
10803 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
10804 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
10805 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10806 }
10807
10808 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
10809
10810 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
10811 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
10812 so that incoming events are handled. */
10813 {
10814 Lisp_Object frame;
10815 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
10816 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
10817 will set it when they are handled. */
10818 bool previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
10819
10820 original_left = f->left_pos;
10821 original_top = f->top_pos;
10822
10823 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
10824 unblock_input ();
10825
10826 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
10827
10828 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
10829 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
10830 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
10831 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
10832
10833 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
10834 because the window manager may choose the position
10835 and we don't want to override it. */
10836
10837 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
10838 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
10839 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
10840 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
10841 && previously_visible)
10842 {
10843 Drawable rootw;
10844 int x, y;
10845 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
10846
10847 block_input ();
10848
10849 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
10850 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
10851 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
10852 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
10853 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
10854 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
10855 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
10856 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
10857 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
10858
10859 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
10860 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
10861 original_left, original_top);
10862
10863 unblock_input ();
10864 }
10865
10866 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
10867
10868 /* Process X events until a MapNotify event has been seen. */
10869 while (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
10870 {
10871 /* Force processing of queued events. */
10872 x_sync (f);
10873
10874 /* If on another desktop, the deiconify/map may be ignored and the
10875 frame never becomes visible. XMonad does this.
10876 Prevent an endless loop. */
10877 if (FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) && ++tries > 100)
10878 break;
10879
10880 /* This hack is still in use at least for Cygwin. See
10881 http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/emacs-devel/2013-12/msg00351.html.
10882
10883 Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
10884 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
10885 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
10886 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
10887 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
10888 probably a bug. */
10889 if (input_polling_used ())
10890 {
10891 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
10892 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
10893 handler reset it. */
10894 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
10895 poll_suppress_count = 1;
10896 poll_for_input_1 ();
10897 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
10898 }
10899
10900 if (XPending (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
10901 {
10902 XEvent xev;
10903 XNextEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), &xev);
10904 x_dispatch_event (&xev, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
10905 }
10906 }
10907 }
10908 }
10909
10910 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
10911
10912 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
10913
10914 void
10915 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
10916 {
10917 Window window;
10918
10919 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
10920 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
10921
10922 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
10923 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
10924 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10925
10926 block_input ();
10927
10928 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
10929 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
10930 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
10931 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
10932 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
10933 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, 0, true);
10934
10935 #ifdef USE_GTK
10936 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
10937 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
10938 else
10939 #else
10940 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
10941 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
10942 else
10943 #endif
10944 {
10945
10946 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
10947 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
10948 {
10949 unblock_input ();
10950 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
10951 }
10952 }
10953
10954 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
10955 just by the event that we get from the server.
10956 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
10957 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
10958 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
10959 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
10960 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, false);
10961
10962 x_sync (f);
10963
10964 unblock_input ();
10965 }
10966
10967 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
10968
10969 void
10970 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
10971 {
10972 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10973 int result;
10974 #endif
10975
10976 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
10977 if (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
10978 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10979
10980 if (FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
10981 return;
10982
10983 block_input ();
10984
10985 x_set_bitmap_icon (f);
10986
10987 #if defined (USE_GTK)
10988 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
10989 {
10990 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
10991 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
10992
10993 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
10994 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
10995 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, true);
10996 unblock_input ();
10997 return;
10998 }
10999 #endif
11000
11001 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11002
11003 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
11004 {
11005 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
11006 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
11007 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
11008 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
11009 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
11010 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
11011 so we have to record it here. */
11012 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
11013 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, true);
11014 unblock_input ();
11015 return;
11016 }
11017
11018 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
11019 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
11020 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
11021 unblock_input ();
11022
11023 if (!result)
11024 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
11025
11026 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, true);
11027 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
11028
11029 block_input ();
11030 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
11031 unblock_input ();
11032 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11033
11034 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
11035 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
11036 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
11037 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
11038 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
11039 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
11040
11041 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
11042 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
11043
11044 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
11045 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
11046 {
11047 XEvent msg;
11048
11049 msg.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
11050 msg.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
11051 msg.xclient.message_type = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
11052 msg.xclient.format = 32;
11053 msg.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
11054
11055 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
11056 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
11057 False,
11058 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
11059 &msg))
11060 {
11061 unblock_input ();
11062 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
11063 }
11064 }
11065
11066 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
11067 IconicState. */
11068 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
11069
11070 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
11071 {
11072 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
11073 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
11074 }
11075
11076 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, true);
11077 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
11078
11079 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
11080 unblock_input ();
11081 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11082 }
11083
11084 \f
11085 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
11086
11087 void
11088 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
11089 {
11090 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
11091 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
11092 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11093 Lisp_Object bar;
11094 struct scroll_bar *b;
11095 #endif
11096
11097 block_input ();
11098
11099 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
11100 commands to the X server. */
11101 if (dpyinfo->display)
11102 {
11103 /* Always exit with visible pointer to avoid weird issue
11104 with Xfixes (Bug#17609). */
11105 if (f->pointer_invisible)
11106 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->toggle_visible_pointer (f, 0);
11107
11108 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
11109 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
11110 face. */
11111 free_frame_faces (f);
11112
11113 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
11114 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
11115
11116 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11117 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
11118 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
11119 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
11120 toolkit scroll bars. */
11121 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
11122 {
11123 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
11124 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
11125 }
11126 #endif
11127
11128 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
11129 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
11130 free_frame_xic (f);
11131 #endif
11132
11133 x_free_cr_resources (f);
11134 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11135 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
11136 {
11137 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
11138 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
11139 }
11140 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
11141 we are using a toolkit. */
11142 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
11143 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
11144
11145 free_frame_menubar (f);
11146
11147 if (f->shell_position)
11148 xfree (f->shell_position);
11149 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11150
11151 #ifdef USE_GTK
11152 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
11153 #endif /* USE_GTK */
11154
11155 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
11156 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
11157 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11158
11159 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
11160 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
11161 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
11162 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
11163 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
11164 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
11165
11166 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
11167 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
11168 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
11169 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
11170 #if defined (USE_LUCID) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
11171 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
11172 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
11173 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
11174 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
11175 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
11176 #endif /* USE_LUCID && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
11177 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel != -1)
11178 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
11179 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel != -1)
11180 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
11181
11182 x_free_gcs (f);
11183
11184 /* Free extra GCs allocated by x_setup_relief_colors. */
11185 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc)
11186 {
11187 XFreeGC (dpyinfo->display, f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc);
11188 f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc = 0;
11189 }
11190 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc)
11191 {
11192 XFreeGC (dpyinfo->display, f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc);
11193 f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc = 0;
11194 }
11195
11196 /* Free cursors. */
11197 if (f->output_data.x->text_cursor != 0)
11198 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->text_cursor);
11199 if (f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor != 0)
11200 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
11201 if (f->output_data.x->modeline_cursor != 0)
11202 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->modeline_cursor);
11203 if (f->output_data.x->hand_cursor != 0)
11204 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->hand_cursor);
11205 if (f->output_data.x->hourglass_cursor != 0)
11206 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->hourglass_cursor);
11207 if (f->output_data.x->horizontal_drag_cursor != 0)
11208 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->horizontal_drag_cursor);
11209 if (f->output_data.x->vertical_drag_cursor != 0)
11210 XFreeCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->vertical_drag_cursor);
11211
11212 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
11213 }
11214
11215 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
11216 xfree (f->output_data.x);
11217 f->output_data.x = NULL;
11218
11219 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
11220 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
11221 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
11222 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
11223 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
11224 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
11225 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
11226 reset_mouse_highlight (hlinfo);
11227
11228 unblock_input ();
11229 }
11230
11231
11232 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
11233
11234 static void
11235 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
11236 {
11237 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
11238
11239 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
11240 commands to the X server. */
11241 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
11242 x_free_frame_resources (f);
11243
11244 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
11245 }
11246
11247 \f
11248 /* Setting window manager hints. */
11249
11250 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
11251 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
11252 that the window now has.
11253 If USER_POSITION, set the USPosition
11254 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
11255 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c. */
11256
11257 #ifndef USE_GTK
11258 void
11259 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, bool user_position)
11260 {
11261 XSizeHints size_hints;
11262 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
11263
11264 if (!window)
11265 return;
11266
11267 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11268 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
11269 {
11270 widget_update_wm_size_hints (f->output_data.x->widget);
11271 return;
11272 }
11273 #endif
11274
11275 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
11276 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
11277
11278 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
11279 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
11280
11281 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
11282 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
11283
11284 size_hints.width_inc = frame_resize_pixelwise ? 1 : FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
11285 size_hints.height_inc = frame_resize_pixelwise ? 1 : FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
11286
11287 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
11288 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
11289 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
11290 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
11291
11292 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
11293 {
11294 int base_width, base_height;
11295 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
11296
11297 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
11298 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
11299
11300 if (frame_resize_pixelwise)
11301 /* Needed to prevent a bad protocol error crash when making the
11302 frame size very small. */
11303 {
11304 min_cols = 2 * min_cols;
11305 min_rows = 2 * min_rows;
11306 }
11307
11308 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
11309 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
11310 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
11311 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
11312 zero-row, zero-column frame.
11313
11314 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
11315 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
11316 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
11317
11318 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
11319 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
11320 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
11321 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
11322 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
11323 }
11324
11325 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
11326 if (flags)
11327 {
11328 size_hints.flags |= flags;
11329 goto no_read;
11330 }
11331
11332 {
11333 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
11334 long supplied_return;
11335 int value;
11336
11337 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
11338 &supplied_return);
11339
11340 if (flags)
11341 size_hints.flags |= flags;
11342 else
11343 {
11344 if (value == 0)
11345 hints.flags = 0;
11346 if (hints.flags & PSize)
11347 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
11348 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
11349 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
11350 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
11351 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
11352 if (hints.flags & USSize)
11353 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
11354 }
11355 }
11356
11357 no_read:
11358
11359 #ifdef PWinGravity
11360 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
11361 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
11362
11363 if (user_position)
11364 {
11365 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
11366 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
11367 }
11368 #endif /* PWinGravity */
11369
11370 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
11371 }
11372 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
11373
11374 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
11375
11376 static void
11377 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
11378 {
11379 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11380 Arg al[1];
11381
11382 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
11383 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
11384 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11385 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
11386
11387 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
11388 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
11389
11390 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
11391 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11392 }
11393
11394 static void
11395 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, ptrdiff_t pixmap_id)
11396 {
11397 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
11398
11399 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
11400 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
11401 #endif
11402
11403 if (pixmap_id > 0)
11404 {
11405 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
11406 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
11407 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
11408 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
11409 }
11410 else
11411 {
11412 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
11413 pixmap. */
11414 return;
11415 }
11416
11417
11418 #ifdef USE_GTK
11419 {
11420 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
11421 return;
11422 }
11423
11424 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
11425
11426 {
11427 Arg al[1];
11428 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
11429 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
11430 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
11431 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
11432 }
11433
11434 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
11435
11436 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
11437 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
11438
11439 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
11440 }
11441
11442 void
11443 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
11444 {
11445 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
11446
11447 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
11448 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
11449 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
11450
11451 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
11452 }
11453
11454 \f
11455 /***********************************************************************
11456 Fonts
11457 ***********************************************************************/
11458
11459 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
11460
11461 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
11462 font table. */
11463
11464 static void
11465 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
11466 {
11467 eassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
11468 if (font->driver->check)
11469 eassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
11470 }
11471
11472 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
11473
11474 \f
11475 /***********************************************************************
11476 Initialization
11477 ***********************************************************************/
11478
11479 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11480 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
11481 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
11482 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
11483
11484 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
11485 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
11486 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
11487
11488 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
11489 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
11490 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
11491 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
11492 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
11493 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
11494 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
11495 };
11496
11497 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
11498
11499 static bool x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
11500
11501 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11502
11503 static int x_initialized;
11504
11505 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
11506 the screen number from the server number. */
11507 static bool
11508 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
11509 {
11510 bool seen_colon = false;
11511 Lisp_Object sysname = Fsystem_name ();
11512 const char *system_name = SSDATA (sysname);
11513 ptrdiff_t system_name_length = SBYTES (sysname);
11514 ptrdiff_t length_until_period = 0;
11515
11516 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
11517 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
11518 length_until_period++;
11519
11520 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
11521 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
11522 name1 += 4;
11523 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
11524 name2 += 4;
11525 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
11526 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
11527 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
11528 name1 += system_name_length;
11529 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
11530 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
11531 name2 += system_name_length;
11532 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
11533 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
11534 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
11535 name1 += length_until_period;
11536 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
11537 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
11538 name2 += length_until_period;
11539
11540 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
11541 {
11542 if (*name1 == ':')
11543 seen_colon = true;
11544 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
11545 return true;
11546 }
11547 return (seen_colon
11548 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
11549 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
11550 }
11551
11552 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
11553 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
11554 to 5. */
11555 static void
11556 get_bits_and_offset (unsigned long mask, int *bits, int *offset)
11557 {
11558 int nr = 0;
11559 int off = 0;
11560
11561 while (!(mask & 1))
11562 {
11563 off++;
11564 mask >>= 1;
11565 }
11566
11567 while (mask & 1)
11568 {
11569 nr++;
11570 mask >>= 1;
11571 }
11572
11573 *offset = off;
11574 *bits = nr;
11575 }
11576
11577 /* Return true iff display DISPLAY is available for use.
11578 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
11579
11580 bool
11581 x_display_ok (const char *display)
11582 {
11583 /* XOpenDisplay fails if it gets a signal. Block SIGIO which may arrive. */
11584 unrequest_sigio ();
11585 Display *dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
11586 request_sigio ();
11587 if (!dpy)
11588 return false;
11589 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
11590 return true;
11591 }
11592
11593 #ifdef USE_GTK
11594 static void
11595 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level,
11596 const gchar *msg, gpointer user_data)
11597 {
11598 if (!strstr (msg, "g_set_prgname"))
11599 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, msg);
11600 }
11601 #endif
11602
11603 /* Create invisible cursor on X display referred by DPYINFO. */
11604
11605 static Cursor
11606 make_invisible_cursor (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
11607 {
11608 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
11609 static char const no_data[] = { 0 };
11610 Pixmap pix;
11611 XColor col;
11612 Cursor c = 0;
11613
11614 x_catch_errors (dpy);
11615 pix = XCreateBitmapFromData (dpy, dpyinfo->root_window, no_data, 1, 1);
11616 if (! x_had_errors_p (dpy) && pix != None)
11617 {
11618 Cursor pixc;
11619 col.pixel = 0;
11620 col.red = col.green = col.blue = 0;
11621 col.flags = DoRed | DoGreen | DoBlue;
11622 pixc = XCreatePixmapCursor (dpy, pix, pix, &col, &col, 0, 0);
11623 if (! x_had_errors_p (dpy) && pixc != None)
11624 c = pixc;
11625 XFreePixmap (dpy, pix);
11626 }
11627
11628 x_uncatch_errors ();
11629
11630 return c;
11631 }
11632
11633 /* True if DPY supports Xfixes extension >= 4. */
11634
11635 static bool
11636 x_probe_xfixes_extension (Display *dpy)
11637 {
11638 #ifdef HAVE_XFIXES
11639 int major, minor;
11640 return XFixesQueryVersion (dpy, &major, &minor) && major >= 4;
11641 #else
11642 return false;
11643 #endif /* HAVE_XFIXES */
11644 }
11645
11646 /* Toggle mouse pointer visibility on frame F by using Xfixes functions. */
11647
11648 static void
11649 xfixes_toggle_visible_pointer (struct frame *f, bool invisible)
11650 {
11651 #ifdef HAVE_XFIXES
11652 if (invisible)
11653 XFixesHideCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
11654 else
11655 XFixesShowCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
11656 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
11657 #else
11658 emacs_abort ();
11659 #endif /* HAVE_XFIXES */
11660 }
11661
11662 /* Toggle mouse pointer visibility on frame F by using invisible cursor. */
11663
11664 static void
11665 x_toggle_visible_pointer (struct frame *f, bool invisible)
11666 {
11667 eassert (FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0);
11668 if (invisible)
11669 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
11670 FRAME_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
11671 else
11672 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
11673 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
11674 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
11675 }
11676
11677 /* Setup pointer blanking, prefer Xfixes if available. */
11678
11679 static void
11680 x_setup_pointer_blanking (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
11681 {
11682 /* FIXME: the brave tester should set EMACS_XFIXES because we're suspecting
11683 X server bug, see http://debbugs.gnu.org/cgi/bugreport.cgi?bug=17609. */
11684 if (egetenv ("EMACS_XFIXES") && x_probe_xfixes_extension (dpyinfo->display))
11685 dpyinfo->toggle_visible_pointer = xfixes_toggle_visible_pointer;
11686 else
11687 {
11688 dpyinfo->toggle_visible_pointer = x_toggle_visible_pointer;
11689 dpyinfo->invisible_cursor = make_invisible_cursor (dpyinfo);
11690 }
11691 }
11692
11693 /* Current X display connection identifier. Incremented for each next
11694 connection established. */
11695 static unsigned x_display_id;
11696
11697 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
11698 the structure that describes the open display.
11699 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
11700
11701 struct x_display_info *
11702 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
11703 {
11704 Display *dpy;
11705 struct terminal *terminal;
11706 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
11707 XrmDatabase xrdb;
11708 ptrdiff_t lim;
11709
11710 block_input ();
11711
11712 if (!x_initialized)
11713 {
11714 x_initialize ();
11715 ++x_initialized;
11716 }
11717
11718 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name)))
11719 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name));
11720
11721 #ifdef USE_GTK
11722 {
11723 #define NUM_ARGV 10
11724 int argc;
11725 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
11726 char **argv2 = argv;
11727 guint id;
11728
11729 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
11730 {
11731 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name), &dpy);
11732 }
11733 else
11734 {
11735 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
11736 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
11737
11738 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
11739 argv[argc] = 0;
11740
11741 argc = 0;
11742 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
11743
11744 if (! NILP (display_name))
11745 {
11746 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
11747 argv[argc++] = SSDATA (display_name);
11748 }
11749
11750 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
11751 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
11752
11753 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
11754
11755 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
11756 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
11757 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
11758 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
11759
11760 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function.
11761 Call before gtk_init so Gtk+ event filters comes after our. */
11762 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
11763
11764 /* gtk_init does set_locale. Fix locale before and after. */
11765 fixup_locale ();
11766 unrequest_sigio (); /* See comment in x_display_ok. */
11767 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
11768 request_sigio ();
11769 fixup_locale ();
11770
11771 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
11772
11773 xg_initialize ();
11774
11775 dpy = DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
11776
11777 #if ! GTK_CHECK_VERSION (2, 90, 0)
11778 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
11779 {
11780 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
11781 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
11782
11783 s = build_string (file);
11784 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
11785
11786 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
11787 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file));
11788 }
11789 #endif
11790
11791 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
11792 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
11793 }
11794 }
11795 #else /* not USE_GTK */
11796 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
11797 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
11798 errors with X11R5:
11799 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
11800 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
11801 So let's not use it until R6. */
11802 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
11803 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
11804 #endif
11805
11806 {
11807 int argc = 0;
11808 char *argv[3];
11809
11810 argv[0] = "";
11811 argc = 1;
11812 if (xrm_option)
11813 {
11814 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
11815 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
11816 }
11817 turn_on_atimers (false);
11818 unrequest_sigio (); /* See comment in x_display_ok. */
11819 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SSDATA (display_name),
11820 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
11821 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
11822 &argc, argv);
11823 request_sigio ();
11824 turn_on_atimers (true);
11825
11826 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
11827 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
11828 fixup_locale ();
11829 #endif
11830 }
11831
11832 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11833 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
11834 unrequest_sigio (); // See comment in x_display_ok.
11835 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name));
11836 request_sigio ();
11837 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
11838 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
11839
11840 /* Detect failure. */
11841 if (dpy == 0)
11842 {
11843 unblock_input ();
11844 return 0;
11845 }
11846
11847 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
11848
11849 dpyinfo = xzalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo);
11850 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
11851
11852 {
11853 struct x_display_info *share;
11854
11855 for (share = x_display_list; share; share = share->next)
11856 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (share->name_list_element)),
11857 SSDATA (display_name)))
11858 break;
11859 if (share)
11860 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
11861 else
11862 {
11863 terminal->kboard = allocate_kboard (Qx);
11864
11865 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
11866 {
11867 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
11868
11869 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
11870 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
11871 unblock_input ();
11872 kset_system_key_alist
11873 (terminal->kboard,
11874 call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
11875 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string));
11876 block_input ();
11877 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
11878 terminal_list = terminal;
11879 }
11880
11881 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
11882 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
11883 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
11884 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
11885 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
11886 }
11887 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
11888 }
11889
11890 /* Put this display on the chain. */
11891 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
11892 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
11893
11894 dpyinfo->name_list_element = Fcons (display_name, Qnil);
11895 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
11896 dpyinfo->connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
11897
11898 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
11899 terminal->name = xlispstrdup (display_name);
11900
11901 #if false
11902 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
11903 #endif
11904
11905 lim = min (PTRDIFF_MAX, SIZE_MAX) - sizeof "@";
11906 Lisp_Object system_name = Fsystem_name ();
11907 if (lim - SBYTES (Vinvocation_name) < SBYTES (system_name))
11908 memory_full (SIZE_MAX);
11909 dpyinfo->x_id = ++x_display_id;
11910 dpyinfo->x_id_name = xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
11911 + SBYTES (system_name) + 2);
11912 char *nametail = lispstpcpy (dpyinfo->x_id_name, Vinvocation_name);
11913 *nametail++ = '@';
11914 lispstpcpy (nametail, system_name);
11915
11916 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
11917 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
11918
11919 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
11920 #ifdef USE_GTK
11921 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
11922 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
11923 #endif /* USE_GTK */
11924
11925 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
11926 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
11927
11928 dpyinfo->horizontal_scroll_bar_cursor
11929 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_h_double_arrow);
11930
11931 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
11932 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
11933 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
11934 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
11935 #else
11936 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
11937 #endif
11938 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
11939 all versions. */
11940 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
11941
11942 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
11943 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
11944 select_visual (dpyinfo);
11945 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
11946 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
11947 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
11948 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
11949
11950 reset_mouse_highlight (&dpyinfo->mouse_highlight);
11951
11952 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
11953 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
11954 {
11955 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
11956 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
11957 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
11958 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
11959 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
11960 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
11961 }
11962
11963 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
11964 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
11965 {
11966 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
11967 {
11968 AUTO_STRING (privateColormap, "privateColormap");
11969 AUTO_STRING (PrivateColormap, "PrivateColormap");
11970 Lisp_Object value
11971 = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo, privateColormap,
11972 PrivateColormap, Qnil, Qnil);
11973 if (STRINGP (value)
11974 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
11975 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
11976 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
11977 }
11978 }
11979 else
11980 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
11981 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
11982
11983 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
11984 {
11985 /* If we are using Xft, the following precautions should be made:
11986
11987 1. Make sure that the Xrender extension is added before the Xft one.
11988 Otherwise, the close-display hook set by Xft is called after the one
11989 for Xrender, and the former tries to re-add the latter. This results
11990 in inconsistency of internal states and leads to X protocol error when
11991 one reconnects to the same X server (Bug#1696).
11992
11993 2. Check dpi value in X resources. It is better we use it as well,
11994 since Xft will use it, as will all Gnome applications. If our real DPI
11995 is smaller or larger than the one Xft uses, our font will look smaller
11996 or larger than other for other applications, even if it is the same
11997 font name (monospace-10 for example). */
11998
11999 int event_base, error_base;
12000 char *v;
12001 double d;
12002
12003 XRenderQueryExtension (dpyinfo->display, &event_base, &error_base);
12004
12005 v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
12006 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
12007 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
12008 }
12009 #endif
12010
12011 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
12012 {
12013 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
12014 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
12015 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
12016 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
12017 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
12018 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
12019 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
12020 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
12021 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
12022 }
12023
12024 {
12025 static const struct
12026 {
12027 const char *name;
12028 int offset;
12029 } atom_refs[] = {
12030 #define ATOM_REFS_INIT(string, member) \
12031 { string, offsetof (struct x_display_info, member) },
12032 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_PROTOCOLS", Xatom_wm_protocols)
12033 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_TAKE_FOCUS", Xatom_wm_take_focus)
12034 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
12035 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_DELETE_WINDOW", Xatom_wm_delete_window)
12036 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_CHANGE_STATE", Xatom_wm_change_state)
12037 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
12038 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_MOVED", Xatom_wm_window_moved)
12039 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_CLIENT_LEADER", Xatom_wm_client_leader)
12040 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("Editres", Xatom_editres)
12041 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("CLIPBOARD", Xatom_CLIPBOARD)
12042 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("TIMESTAMP", Xatom_TIMESTAMP)
12043 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("TEXT", Xatom_TEXT)
12044 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("COMPOUND_TEXT", Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT)
12045 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("UTF8_STRING", Xatom_UTF8_STRING)
12046 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("DELETE", Xatom_DELETE)
12047 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("MULTIPLE", Xatom_MULTIPLE)
12048 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("INCR", Xatom_INCR)
12049 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_EMACS_TMP_", Xatom_EMACS_TMP)
12050 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("TARGETS", Xatom_TARGETS)
12051 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("NULL", Xatom_NULL)
12052 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("ATOM", Xatom_ATOM)
12053 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("ATOM_PAIR", Xatom_ATOM_PAIR)
12054 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("CLIPBOARD_MANAGER", Xatom_CLIPBOARD_MANAGER)
12055 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_XEMBED_INFO", Xatom_XEMBED_INFO)
12056 /* For properties of font. */
12057 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("PIXEL_SIZE", Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE)
12058 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("AVERAGE_WIDTH", Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH)
12059 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET)
12060 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE)
12061 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT)
12062 /* Ghostscript support. */
12063 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("DONE", Xatom_DONE)
12064 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("PAGE", Xatom_PAGE)
12065 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("SCROLLBAR", Xatom_Scrollbar)
12066 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("HORIZONTAL_SCROLLBAR", Xatom_Horizontal_Scrollbar)
12067 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_XEMBED", Xatom_XEMBED)
12068 /* EWMH */
12069 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE", Xatom_net_wm_state)
12070 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
12071 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
12072 Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
12073 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
12074 Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
12075 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
12076 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_HIDDEN", Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden)
12077 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", Xatom_net_window_type)
12078 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
12079 Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip)
12080 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", Xatom_net_wm_icon_name)
12081 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_NAME", Xatom_net_wm_name)
12082 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_SUPPORTED", Xatom_net_supported)
12083 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check)
12084 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity)
12085 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", Xatom_net_active_window)
12086 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", Xatom_net_frame_extents)
12087 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_CURRENT_DESKTOP", Xatom_net_current_desktop)
12088 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WORKAREA", Xatom_net_workarea)
12089 /* Session management */
12090 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("SM_CLIENT_ID", Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID)
12091 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", Xatom_xsettings_prop)
12092 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("MANAGER", Xatom_xsettings_mgr)
12093 };
12094
12095 int i;
12096 enum { atom_count = ARRAYELTS (atom_refs) };
12097 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN. */
12098 enum { total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count };
12099 Atom atoms_return[total_atom_count];
12100 char *atom_names[total_atom_count];
12101 static char const xsettings_fmt[] = "_XSETTINGS_S%d";
12102 char xsettings_atom_name[sizeof xsettings_fmt - 2
12103 + INT_STRLEN_BOUND (int)];
12104
12105 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
12106 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
12107
12108 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name. */
12109 sprintf (xsettings_atom_name, xsettings_fmt,
12110 XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
12111 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
12112
12113 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
12114 False, atoms_return);
12115
12116 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
12117 *(Atom *) ((char *) dpyinfo + atom_refs[i].offset) = atoms_return[i];
12118
12119 /* Manually copy last atom. */
12120 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
12121 }
12122
12123 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
12124 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms
12125 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
12126 dpyinfo->gray
12127 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
12128 gray_bits, gray_width, gray_height,
12129 1, 0, 1);
12130
12131 x_setup_pointer_blanking (dpyinfo);
12132
12133 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
12134 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
12135 #endif
12136
12137 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
12138
12139 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
12140 if (dpyinfo->connection != 0)
12141 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
12142
12143 #ifdef F_SETOWN
12144 fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
12145 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
12146
12147 if (interrupt_input)
12148 init_sigio (dpyinfo->connection);
12149
12150 #ifdef USE_LUCID
12151 {
12152 XrmValue d, fr, to;
12153 Font font;
12154
12155 dpy = dpyinfo->display;
12156 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
12157 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
12158 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
12159 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
12160 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
12161 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
12162 x_catch_errors (dpy);
12163 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
12164 emacs_abort ();
12165 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
12166 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
12167 /* Do not free XFontStruct returned by the above call to XQueryFont.
12168 This leads to X protocol errors at XtCloseDisplay (Bug#18403). */
12169 x_uncatch_errors ();
12170 }
12171 #endif
12172
12173 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
12174 for debugging X code. */
12175 {
12176 AUTO_STRING (synchronous, "synchronous");
12177 AUTO_STRING (Synchronous, "Synchronous");
12178 Lisp_Object value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo, synchronous,
12179 Synchronous, Qnil, Qnil);
12180 if (STRINGP (value)
12181 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
12182 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
12183 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
12184 }
12185
12186 {
12187 AUTO_STRING (useXIM, "useXIM");
12188 AUTO_STRING (UseXIM, "UseXIM");
12189 Lisp_Object value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo, useXIM, UseXIM,
12190 Qnil, Qnil);
12191 #ifdef USE_XIM
12192 if (STRINGP (value)
12193 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "false")
12194 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "off")))
12195 use_xim = false;
12196 #else
12197 if (STRINGP (value)
12198 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
12199 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
12200 use_xim = true;
12201 #endif
12202 }
12203
12204 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
12205 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
12206 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
12207 tty or started as a daemon. */
12208 if (terminal->id == 1 && ! IS_DAEMON)
12209 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
12210 #endif
12211
12212 #ifdef USE_CAIRO
12213 x_extension_initialize (dpyinfo);
12214 #endif
12215
12216 unblock_input ();
12217
12218 return dpyinfo;
12219 }
12220 \f
12221 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
12222 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
12223
12224 static void
12225 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
12226 {
12227 struct terminal *t;
12228 struct color_name_cache_entry *color_entry, *next_color_entry;
12229
12230 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
12231 X display. */
12232 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
12233 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
12234 {
12235 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
12236 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
12237 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
12238 x_session_close ();
12239 #endif
12240 delete_terminal (t);
12241 break;
12242 }
12243
12244 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
12245 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
12246
12247 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
12248 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
12249 else
12250 {
12251 struct x_display_info *tail;
12252
12253 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
12254 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
12255 tail->next = tail->next->next;
12256 }
12257
12258 for (color_entry = dpyinfo->color_names;
12259 color_entry;
12260 color_entry = next_color_entry)
12261 {
12262 next_color_entry = color_entry->next;
12263 xfree (color_entry->name);
12264 xfree (color_entry);
12265 }
12266
12267 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
12268 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
12269 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
12270 xfree (dpyinfo);
12271 }
12272
12273 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
12274
12275 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
12276 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
12277 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
12278 that slows us down. */
12279
12280 static void
12281 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
12282 {
12283 block_input ();
12284 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = false;
12285 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
12286 {
12287 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
12288 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
12289 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
12290 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
12291 }
12292 unblock_input ();
12293 }
12294
12295 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
12296 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
12297 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
12298 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
12299 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
12300 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
12301 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
12302
12303 void
12304 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
12305 {
12306 block_input ();
12307 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
12308 {
12309 struct timespec interval = make_timespec (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
12310 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
12311 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = true;
12312 }
12313 unblock_input ();
12314 }
12315
12316 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
12317
12318 \f
12319 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
12320
12321 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
12322 {
12323 x_frame_parm_handlers,
12324 x_produce_glyphs,
12325 x_write_glyphs,
12326 x_insert_glyphs,
12327 x_clear_end_of_line,
12328 x_scroll_run,
12329 x_after_update_window_line,
12330 x_update_window_begin,
12331 x_update_window_end,
12332 x_flush,
12333 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
12334 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
12335 x_fix_overlapping_area,
12336 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
12337 #ifdef USE_CAIRO
12338 x_cr_define_fringe_bitmap,
12339 x_cr_destroy_fringe_bitmap,
12340 #else
12341 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
12342 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
12343 #endif
12344 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
12345 x_draw_glyph_string,
12346 x_define_frame_cursor,
12347 x_clear_frame_area,
12348 x_draw_window_cursor,
12349 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
12350 x_draw_window_divider,
12351 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert, /* Never called; see comment in function. */
12352 x_show_hourglass,
12353 x_hide_hourglass
12354 };
12355
12356
12357 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
12358 void
12359 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
12360 {
12361 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
12362
12363 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
12364 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
12365 if (!terminal->name)
12366 return;
12367
12368 block_input ();
12369 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
12370 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
12371 X display. */
12372 if (dpyinfo->xim)
12373 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
12374 #endif
12375
12376 /* Normally, the display is available... */
12377 if (dpyinfo->display)
12378 {
12379 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
12380 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
12381
12382 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
12383 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
12384 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
12385 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
12386
12387 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
12388 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
12389 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
12390 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
12391 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
12392 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
12393 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
12394 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
12395 leaks in other situations. */
12396 #if false
12397 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
12398 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
12399 #else
12400 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
12401 #endif
12402 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
12403 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
12404 closing all the displays. */
12405 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
12406 #endif
12407
12408 #ifdef USE_GTK
12409 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
12410 #else
12411 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
12412 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
12413 #else
12414 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
12415 #endif
12416 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
12417 /* Do not close the connection here because it's already closed
12418 by X(t)CloseDisplay (Bug#18403). */
12419 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
12420 }
12421
12422 /* ...but if called from x_connection_closed, the display may already
12423 be closed and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. Since
12424 X server is most likely gone, explicit close is the only reliable
12425 way to continue and avoid Bug#19147. */
12426 else if (dpyinfo->connection >= 0)
12427 emacs_close (dpyinfo->connection);
12428
12429 /* No more input on this descriptor. */
12430 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
12431 /* Mark as dead. */
12432 dpyinfo->connection = -1;
12433
12434 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
12435 unblock_input ();
12436 }
12437
12438 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
12439 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
12440
12441 static struct terminal *
12442 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
12443 {
12444 struct terminal *terminal;
12445
12446 terminal = create_terminal (output_x_window, &x_redisplay_interface);
12447
12448 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
12449 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
12450
12451 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
12452
12453 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
12454 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
12455 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
12456 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
12457 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
12458 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
12459 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
12460 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
12461 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
12462 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
12463 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
12464 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
12465 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
12466 terminal->menu_show_hook = x_menu_show;
12467 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
12468 terminal->popup_dialog_hook = xw_popup_dialog;
12469 #endif
12470 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
12471 terminal->set_horizontal_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_horizontal_scroll_bar;
12472 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
12473 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
12474 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
12475 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
12476 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
12477 /* Other hooks are NULL by default. */
12478
12479 return terminal;
12480 }
12481
12482 static void
12483 x_initialize (void)
12484 {
12485 baud_rate = 19200;
12486
12487 x_noop_count = 0;
12488 any_help_event_p = false;
12489 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
12490
12491 #ifdef USE_GTK
12492 current_count = -1;
12493 #endif
12494
12495 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
12496 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
12497
12498 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
12499 XtToolkitInitialize ();
12500
12501 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
12502
12503 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
12504 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
12505 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
12506 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
12507 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
12508 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
12509 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
12510
12511 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
12512 #endif
12513
12514 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
12515 #ifndef USE_GTK
12516 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
12517 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
12518 #endif
12519 #endif
12520
12521 #ifdef USE_CAIRO
12522 x_cr_init_fringe (&x_redisplay_interface);
12523 #endif
12524
12525 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
12526 original error handler. */
12527 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
12528 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
12529 }
12530
12531 #ifdef USE_GTK
12532 void
12533 init_xterm (void)
12534 {
12535 /* Emacs can handle only core input events, so make sure
12536 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
12537 xputenv ("GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1");
12538 }
12539 #endif
12540
12541 void
12542 syms_of_xterm (void)
12543 {
12544 x_error_message = NULL;
12545
12546 DEFSYM (Qvendor_specific_keysyms, "vendor-specific-keysyms");
12547 DEFSYM (Qlatin_1, "latin-1");
12548
12549 #ifdef USE_GTK
12550 xg_default_icon_file = build_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
12551 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
12552
12553 DEFSYM (Qx_gtk_map_stock, "x-gtk-map-stock");
12554 #endif
12555
12556 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
12557 x_use_underline_position_properties,
12558 doc: /* Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
12559 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
12560 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
12561 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
12562 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
12563 sizes. */);
12564 x_use_underline_position_properties = true;
12565
12566 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
12567 x_underline_at_descent_line,
12568 doc: /* Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
12569 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
12570 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
12571 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
12572 x_underline_at_descent_line = false;
12573
12574 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
12575 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
12576 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
12577 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
12578 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
12579 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
12580 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
12581 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
12582 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = false;
12583
12584 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
12585 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
12586 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
12587 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
12588 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
12589 With MS Windows or Nextstep, the value is t. */);
12590 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
12591 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
12592 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
12593 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
12594 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
12595 #elif USE_GTK
12596 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
12597 #else
12598 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
12599 #endif
12600 #else
12601 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
12602 #endif
12603
12604 DEFSYM (Qmodifier_value, "modifier-value");
12605 DEFSYM (Qalt, "alt");
12606 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
12607 DEFSYM (Qhyper, "hyper");
12608 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
12609 DEFSYM (Qmeta, "meta");
12610 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
12611 DEFSYM (Qsuper, "super");
12612 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
12613
12614 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym,
12615 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
12616 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
12617 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
12618 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
12619 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
12620
12621 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym,
12622 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
12623 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
12624 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
12625 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
12626 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
12627
12628 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym,
12629 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
12630 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
12631 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
12632 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
12633 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
12634
12635 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym,
12636 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
12637 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
12638 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
12639 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
12640 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
12641
12642 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table,
12643 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
12644 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (hashtest_eql, make_number (900),
12645 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
12646 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
12647 Qnil);
12648
12649 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-frame-normalize-before-maximize",
12650 x_frame_normalize_before_maximize,
12651 doc: /* Non-nil means normalize frame before maximizing.
12652 If this variable is t, Emacs first asks the window manager to give the
12653 frame its normal size, and only then the final state, whenever changing
12654 from a full-height, full-width or full-both state to the maximized one
12655 or when changing from the maximized to the full-height or full-width
12656 state.
12657
12658 Set this variable only if your window manager cannot handle the
12659 transition between the various maximization states. */);
12660 x_frame_normalize_before_maximize = false;
12661 }